Disclaimer
All
of the für
following
PDF document for
this sich
vehicle
model
Daslanguage
folgende versions
PDF-Dokument
dieses Fahrzeugmodell
bezieht
in allen
relate
solely toversion
vehicles
intended
for sale
on the
German
which
Sprachversionen
nur aufofdie
die für
den
deutschen
Marktand
bestimmt
The
following
theFahrzeuge,
Owner‘s
Manual
describes
allmarket
models,
series
and
correspond
to German
regulations.
sind undequipment
die den
deutschen
Vorschriften
entsprechen. Bitte
wenden
Sie sich an
special
of your
vehicle. Country-specific
language
variations
are
Ihren autorisierten
Mercedes-Benz
Servicestützpunkt,
um equipped
ein gedrucktes
possible.
Please note
that your vehicle
might not be
withExemplar
all the
Please
contact
your authorised
Mercedes-Benz
Service
Centreand
to obtain
für andere
Fahrzeugmodelle
und affects
Fahrzeugmodelljahre
zu erhalten.
described
functions.
This also
safety-relevant
systems
functions.
a printed
version
forauthorised
other vehicle
models and vehicle
model
years.
Thislike
PDF
Please
contact
your
Mercedes-Benz
dealership
if you
would
document
the latest
version.
Possible
variations
to your
vehicle
mayzu
not
Dieses
PDF-Dokument
stellt
die Manual
aktuelle
Version
dar.
Mögliche
Abweichungen
to
receive
aisprinted
Owner‘s
for other
vehicle
models
and vehicle
be
taken
into account
askönnten
Mercedes-Benz
constantlysein,
updates
their vehicles to
Ihrem
konkreten
Fahrzeug
nicht berücksichtigt
da Mercedes-Benz
model
years.
the
state
of the art
and introduces
changes
design
andanpasst,
equipment.
seine
Fahrzeuge
ständig
dem neuesten
Standinder
Technik
sowiePlease
therefore
that this
PDF is
document
in no
way
replaces
the
version
Änderungen
in Form
und
Ausstattung
vornimmt.
Bitte
beachten
Sie
daher,
dass
The
onlinenote
Owner‘s
Manual
the current
and
valid
version.
Itprinted
is
possible
that
which
was affecting
deliveredyour
with
yourFall
vehicle.
dieses PDF-Dokument
in keinem
das gedruckte
ersetzt,
mit
deviations
specific
vehicle
could Exemplar
not be taken
intodas
account
dem
Fahrzeug ausgeliefert
wurde.
as
Mercedes-Benz
constantly
adapts its vehicles according to the latest
technology and makes changes to the form and the equipment.
Please also read the printed Owner‘s Manual, supplementary documents and
the digital Owner‘s Manual in the vehicle.
Copyright
All rights reserved. All texts, images and graphics are subject to copyright
and other laws for the protection of intellectual property. They may not be
copied or changed for any commercial use or for the purpose of being passed
on nor used on other webistes.
Internal use only
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
Thank you for choosing Mercedes-Benz.
Before you drive off, familiarise yourself with
your vehicle and read the Owner's Manual.
This will help you to obtain the maximum
pleasure from your vehicle and to avoid
endangering yourself and others.
Items of optional equipment are marked with
an asterisk *.
The equipment in your vehicle may vary,
depending on the model, the ordered items,
the country specifications and availability.
The illustrations in this Owner's Manual show
a left-hand-drive vehicle. The arrangement of
the switches, levers, stowage compartments,
etc. will differ accordingly in a right-handdrive vehicle.
Mercedes-Benz is constantly updating its
vehicles to the state of the art and therefore
reserves the right to introduce changes in
design, equipment and technical features at
any time. You cannot, therefore, base any
claims on the data, illustrations or descriptions in this Owner's Manual.
Please consult a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre if you have any questions.
The Owner’s Manual, Brief Instructions,
service booklet and supplements related to
vehicle equipment belong with the vehicle.
You should always keep them in the vehicle
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 1
Version: 2.10.6
and pass them on to the new owner if you sell
the vehicle.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
i You can get to know the important fea-
tures of your vehicle in German and in English in the interactive Owner's Manual on
the Internet at:
www.mercedes-benz.de/betriebsanleitung
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
Contents
Index........................................................ 3
Introduction.......................................... 15
At a glance............................................ 19
Safety.................................................... 35
Controls................................................ 59
Operation............................................ 167
Practical advice................................. 199
Technical data.................................... 273
2
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 2
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 3
Version: 2.10.6
Index
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System).......... 55
Display message............ 204, 205, 206
Warning lamp.................................. 224
Acceleration
Technical data................................ 281
Accident
Notes.............................................. 231
Active head restraint........................... 42
Active Park Assist
Display messages........................... 210
Active parking assist......................... 123
Trailer towing.................................. 127
Active Service System PLUS
see Service indicator
Adaptive brake lamps.......................... 56
Airbag
Activation.......................................... 37
Control unit....................................... 37
Driver's............................................. 40
Front................................................. 40
Front passenger................................ 40
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp .............................................. 223
Sidebags........................................... 41
System.............................................. 39
Windowbags..................................... 42
Airbags
Head/thorax airbags........................ 41
Air conditioning
Activating/deactivating.................. 135
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode................................. 141
Air-conditioning system.................. 132
Controlling automatically................ 136
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode).................. 141
Cooling with air dehumidification. . . 136
Demisting the windscreen.............. 139
Heatmatic....................................... 131
Malfunction indicator lamp............. 222
Misted-up windows......................... 140
Rear window heating...................... 140
Setting the air distribution.............. 138
Setting the airflow.......................... 139
Setting the air vents....................... 137
Setting the temperature................. 136
Switching the residual heat function on/off...................................... 142
Thermotronic.................................. 134
Air-conditioning system
see Air conditioning
Antifreeze concentration................... 299
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS
Anti-theft alarm system
see ATA
Anti-theft systems................................ 57
Armrest
Front seat (adjusting)........................ 67
Rear seat (adjusting)......................... 68
Removing/fitting............................ 148
Ashtray................................................ 162
ASSYST PLUS
see Service interval display
ASSYST PLUS service indicator........ 191
ATA (anti-theft alarm system)............. 57
Switching off the alarm..................... 57
Audible warning signal...................... 230
AUTO lights
Display message............................. 216
Automatic car wash........................... 193
Automatic engine start
Using the ECO Start-Stop function. . . 91
With ECO start/stop function........... 89
Automatic transmission
Changing gear yourself..................... 95
Display message............................. 209
Driving tips....................................... 96
Emergency running mode............... 235
Malfunction..................................... 235
One-touch gearshifting..................... 95
Program selector button................... 96
Trailer towing.................................... 96
Working on the vehicle..................... 96
AUTOTRONIC
Releasing the parking lock manually................................................ 243
3
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 4
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Axle load, maximum permissible
..................................................... 287, 289
B
Backrest
Removing/fitting............................ 152
Bag hook............................................. 158
Ball coupling
Fitting............................................. 186
Removing........................................ 190
BAS (Brake Assist)............................... 55
Battery
Changing (key)................................ 244
Charging......................................... 265
Checking (key)................................ 244
Check lamp (key)............................ 244
Disconnecting................................. 265
Display message............................. 213
Jump starting.................................. 266
Maintenance (vehicle)..................... 263
Reconnecting.................................. 266
Removing/fitting............................ 265
Vehicle battery............................... 263
Belt force limiters
Activation.......................................... 37
Belt height adjustment........................ 75
Belt tensioners
Activation.......................................... 37
Belt warning.......................................... 75
4
Bonnet
Bonnet catch.................................. 172
Opening/closing ............................ 171
Bonnet release lever
Release lever.................................. 171
Brake Assist
see BAS
Brake fluid.......................................... 300
Display message............................. 214
Brake lamps
Adaptive............................................ 56
Display message............................. 217
Brakes
Parking brake.................................... 90
Warning lamp.................................. 226
Brake system
Display message............................. 213
Bulbs
Brake lamp..................................... 250
Cornering light................................ 248
Dipped-beam headlamps................ 247
Display messages........................... 216
Licence plate lamp.......................... 250
Main-beam headlamps................... 248
Overview......................................... 245
Parking lamp................................... 248
Rear foglamp.................................. 250
Replacing................................ 247, 249
Reversing lamp............................... 250
Side lamp........................................ 248
Tail lamp......................................... 250
Turn signal lamp..................... 249, 250
C
Calling up a malfunction
see Message memory menu
Care..................................................... 192
Automatic car wash........................ 193
Exhaust tail pipes............................ 196
Headlamps..................................... 194
High-pressure cleaners................... 193
Parktronic....................................... 196
Plastic trim..................................... 195
Rear window................................... 194
Side windows.................................. 194
Trailer tow hitch.............................. 196
CD player/CD changer
Operating (on-board computer)
....................................................... 104
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer).............................................. 111
Key................................................... 60
Central locking/unlocking button...... 61
Central unlocking
Key................................................... 60
Centre console
Lower section................................... 32
Upper section................................... 31
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 5
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Changing a wheel
see Flat tyre
Child-proof locks
Rear doors........................................ 54
Children
Fastening seat belts.......................... 51
In the vehicle.................................... 42
Restraint systems............................. 43
Child seat
Automatic recognition...................... 45
Automatic recognition (malfunction)................................................ 223
Integrated......................................... 50
ISOFIX............................................... 48
Recommendations............................ 47
Suitable positions............................. 46
Cigarette lighter................................. 163
Cockpit
Overview........................................... 22
COMAND............................................. 101
On-board computer........................ 101
see separate operating instructions
Constant headlamp mode
Setting (on-board computer)........... 109
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer)........................................... 112
Convenience closing............................ 86
Convenience opening........................... 86
Coolant................................................ 175
Checking the level.......................... 175
Display message............ 213, 214, 215
Mixture ratio................................... 297
Temperature gauge........................... 97
Cornering light
Display message............................. 216
Cruise control..................................... 115
Cup holder.......................................... 144
D
Dashboard
see Instrument cluster
Date
Setting (on-board computer)...........
Daytime driving lights
see Constant headlamp mode
Delayed switch-off
Exterior lighting (on-board computer)..............................................
Interior lighting (on-board computer)..............................................
Diesel
Low outside temperatures..............
Diesel engine
Winter driving.................................
Digital speedometer..........................
Dipped-beam headlamps
Display message.............................
Symmetrical...................................
109
110
110
170
170
103
216
185
Display message................................ 202
Service interval display................... 191
Display messages
Symbol messages........................... 212
Text messages................................ 203
Distance recorder
see Total distance recorder
see Trip meter
Distance Recorder
see Trip meter
Door
Automatic locking............................. 61
Display message............................. 212
Emergency locking......................... 242
Emergency unlocking...................... 241
Opening (from the inside)................. 61
Door control panel
Overview........................................... 34
Drinks holder
see Cup holder
Driver's airbag...................................... 40
Driver's seat position........................... 76
Driving abroad.................................... 185
Driving safety system.......................... 55
ABS................................................... 55
Adaptive brake lamps....................... 56
BAS................................................... 55
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL................................................. 56
5
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 6
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Driving safety systems
ESP® ................................................ 56
Driving system................................... 115
Active parking assist....................... 123
Cruise control................................. 115
ECO start/stop function................. 127
Parktronic....................................... 120
Speedtronic.................................... 117
Driving tip
Braking........................................... 183
Trailer towing.................................. 188
Winter............................................. 182
Driving tips
Driving abroad ............................... 185
Driving on wet roads ...................... 185
Fording .......................................... 185
DVD audio
Operating (on-board computer)...... 104
DVD video
Operating (on-board computer)...... 105
E
Easy-entry feature................................ 67
EASY-VARIO-PLUS system................. 149
EASY-VARIO system........................... 149
ECO start/stop function.................... 127
Electrical/electronic equipment
Retrofitting..................................... 275
6
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP®
e mark................................................. 275
Emergency key element
Lost................................................ 239
Emergency locking
Vehicle............................................ 242
Emergency release
Fuel filler flap.................................. 242
Emergency running mode
Automatic transmission.................. 235
Emergency starting............................ 270
Emergency unlocking
Vehicle............................................ 241
Engine
Display message............................. 212
Running irregularly.......................... 234
Starting problems........................... 233
Starting with ECO start/stop
function............................................ 89
Starting with the key......................... 87
Switching off..................................... 91
Switching off using the ECO StartStop function.................................... 91
Technical data................................ 278
Engine diagnostics warning lamp
............................................................. 227
Engine electronics.............................. 275
Malfunction..................................... 233
Engine number................................... 277
Engine oil ........................................... 296
Capacities....................................... 174
Checking the oil level (dipstick)...... 174
Checking the oil level (on-board
computer)....................................... 173
Consumption ................................. 172
Display message
....................................... 173, 219, 220
Filler neck....................................... 174
Topping up...................................... 174
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)... 56
Display messages........... 207, 208, 209
Warning lamp........................... 56, 226
Exterior lighting
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer)....................................... 110
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting.......................................... 71
Folding in/out (automatically).......... 72
Folding in/out (electrically).............. 72
Folding in when locking (on-board
computer)....................................... 111
Malfunction..................................... 238
Resetting.......................................... 72
Exterior view
Overview........................................... 20
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 7
Version: 2.10.6
Index
F
Fastening seat belts
Children............................................ 51
Fire extinguisher................................ 201
First-aid kit......................................... 200
Flat tyre
Equipment...................................... 253
MOExtended run-flat system.......... 262
Preparing the vehicle...................... 253
TIREFIT kit....................................... 253
Floormat.............................................. 165
Foglamps
Display message............................. 218
Fording................................................ 185
Frequencies
Telephone....................................... 276
Front airbag.......................................... 40
Front-passenger airbag........................ 40
Front-passenger seat
Folding the backrest forward/
back................................................ 158
Removing/fitting............................ 156
Fuel...................................................... 292
Diesel............................................. 170
Gauge............................................... 26
Loss................................................ 232
Petrol.............................................. 169
Fuel consumption...................... 293, 294
Fuel filler flap
Emergency release.........................
Opening/closing ............................
Fuel filter
Display message.............................
Fuel level
Calling up the range (on-board
computer).......................................
Fuel line
Malfunction.....................................
Fuel tank
Defect.............................................
Fuse allocation chart.........................
Fuse box..............................................
Fuses...................................................
242
168
214
113
232
232
271
271
271
G
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts.......... 274
Glove compartment........................... 160
Gross vehicle weight, maximum
permissible................................. 287, 288
H
Handbrake
Display message............................. 214
Head/thorax airbags........................... 41
Headlamps
Cleaning......................................... 194
Cleaning system............................... 81
Misting up....................................... 237
Headlamps delayed switch-off
see Exterior lighting delayed switch-off
Head restraint
Active head restraint......................... 42
Adjusting (front).......................... 64, 65
Adjusting (rear)................................. 66
Removing (rear)................................ 66
Heating
see Air conditioning
High-pressure cleaners..................... 193
Hill start assist..................................... 90
I
Immobiliser........................................... 57
Indicator and warning lamp
Air conditioning (malfunction)......... 222
Automatic child seat recognition
(malfunction).................................. 223
Brakes (red).................................... 226
Engine diagnostics.......................... 227
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF......... 45, 223
Reserve fuel.................................... 229
Seat belt......................................... 228
SRS........................................... 37, 226
Thermotronic (malfunction)............ 222
Indicator and warning lamps............ 224
7
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 8
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Indicator lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Instrument cluster............................... 97
Overview........................................... 26
Selecting the language (on-board
computer)....................................... 108
Instrument lighting.............................. 97
Integrated child seat............................ 50
Interior lighting
Automatic control system................. 82
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer)....................................... 110
Emergency lighting........................... 83
Manual control.................................. 82
Reading lamp.................................... 82
Interior motion sensor......................... 58
ISOFIX child seat securing system..... 48
J
Jack......................................................
Operation........................................
Jump-starting......................................
Jump leads......................................
200
259
266
266
K
Key......................................................... 60
Changing the battery...................... 244
Checking the battery...................... 244
Display message............................. 220
8
Loss................................................ 239
Malfunction..................................... 239
Modifying the programming.............. 60
Key positions
Key................................................... 62
Kickdown.............................................. 96
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Lashing eyelets.................................. 146
Licence plate lighting
Display message............................. 218
Light bulbs
see Bulbs
Lighting
see Lights
Lights
Automatic headlamp mode............... 78
Constant headlamp mode................. 78
Cornering light function.................... 81
Dipped-beam headlamps.................. 78
Display messages........................... 216
Foglamps.......................................... 79
Hazard warning lamps...................... 80
Headlamp flasher.............................. 80
Headlamp range............................... 80
Light switch...................................... 77
Main-beam headlamps...................... 80
Rear fog lamp................................... 79
Switching off (display message)...... 218
Turn signals...................................... 79
LIM indicator lamp
Cruise control................................. 116
Variable Speedtronic...................... 118
Load compartment load, maximum
..................................................... 288, 289
Loading guidelines............................. 145
Locking
Automatic......................................... 61
Emergency locking......................... 242
From the inside (central locking
button).............................................. 61
Luggage compartment enlargement.................................................... 150
Luggage compartment floor
Adjusting the height....................... 155
stowage well, under........................ 154
Luggage cover.................................... 159
Luggage net........................................ 145
Lumbar support.................................... 68
M
Main-beam headlamps
Display message............................. 218
Main fuse box..................................... 271
Maintenance
Battery............................................ 263
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 9
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Malfunction memory
see Message memory menu
Manual transmission........................... 92
Maximum speed
Technical data................................ 280
Memory card...................................... 104
Operating (on-board computer)...... 104
see separate operating instructions
Menu (on-board computer)................ 101
Audio.............................................. 103
DVD................................................ 105
Message memory........................... 106
Navigation...................................... 105
Operating........................................ 102
Resetting to factory settings........... 106
Settings.......................................... 106
Submenu overview......................... 107
Telephone....................................... 113
Trip computer................................. 112
Messages
see Display messages
see Message memory menu
see Warning and indicator lamps
Minispare emergency spare wheel
Technical data................................ 285
Mirrors
Sun visor......................................... 162
Mobile phone...................................... 164
Display message..................... 210, 220
Installation...................................... 275
Telephone menu (on-board computer).............................................. 113
Modifying the programming
Key................................................... 60
MOExtended run-flat system*. . 178, 262
MP3..................................................... 104
Operating (on-board computer)
....................................................... 104
see separate operating instructions
Multi-contour backrest........................ 69
Multi-function display.................. 97, 100
Multi-function steering wheel............. 98
Overview........................................... 30
N
Navigation........................................... 105
Navigation menu (on-board computer).............................................. 105
see separate operating instructions
O
Odometer
Total distance recorder..................... 26
Trip meter......................................... 26
Oil
Consumption.................................. 172
Topping up...................................... 174
Oil level
Checking (dipstick)......................... 174
Checking (on-board computer)....... 173
On-board computer.............................. 98
Audio menu.................................... 103
Convenience submenu................... 108
Display messages........................... 202
DVD menu...................................... 105
Factory settings.............................. 106
Instrument cluster submenu........... 107
Lighting submenu........................... 108
Message memory menu.................. 106
Navigation menu............................. 105
Operation menu.............................. 102
Settings menu................................ 106
Standard display menu................... 103
Telephone menu............................. 113
Time/date submenu....................... 107
Trip computer menu....................... 112
Vehicle submenu............................ 108
On-board computer language........... 108
One-touch gearshifting........................ 95
Operating system
see On-board computer
Outside temperature display ............. 98
On-board computer........................ 103
Override feature
Rear side windows............................ 54
9
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 10
Version: 2.10.6
Index
P
Padded table
Integrated child seat......................... 51
Paint code number............................. 276
Park Assist
Display messages........................... 210
Parking.................................................. 90
Parking aid
Active parking assist....................... 123
Display message............................. 210
Parktronic....................................... 120
Parking brake....................................... 90
Display message............................. 214
Parking lamps
Display message............................. 218
Parking lock
Releasing manually (AUTOTRONIC).......................................... 243
Parktronic........................................... 120
Activating/deactivating.................. 122
Malfunction..................................... 236
Range of the sensors...................... 121
Trailer towing.................................. 123
Warning display.............................. 121
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp.............................................. 45, 223
Performance....................................... 280
Permanent Speedtronic..................... 120
10
Petrol
Minimum grade............................... 169
Plastic trim
Cleaning......................................... 195
Power supply (trailer)........................ 190
Power window switch
see Side windows
Program selector button
Automatic transmission.................... 96
Pulling away.......................................... 89
R
Radio
Changing a station (on-board
computer)....................................... 103
Setting for station selection (onboard computer)............................. 111
see separate operating instructions
Range (on-board computer).............. 113
Rear bench seat
Folding forward............................... 150
Rear-compartment seat belt status indicator......................................... 76
Rear foglamp
Display message............................. 218
Rear-view mirror
Adjusting.......................................... 70
Anti-dazzle (manual)......................... 70
Anti-dazzle mode (automatic)........... 70
Rear window
Cleaning......................................... 194
Rear window heating......................... 140
Malfunction indicator lamp............. 223
Rear window wiper.............................. 83
Replacing the wiper blade............... 251
Refuelling............................................ 168
Replacing the wiper blades............... 251
Reserve
Warning lamp.................................. 229
Reserve fuel........................................ 292
Display message............................. 220
Fuel tank......................................... 292
Warning lamp........................... 26, 229
Reset button......................................... 97
Restraint system
see SRS
see SRS (Supplemental Restraint
System)
Restraint systems
For children...................................... 43
Rev counter........................................... 98
Reverse gear
Engaging (automatic transmission)... 94
Engaging (manual transmission)
................................................... 92, 93
Reversing lamp
Display message............................. 219
Roof load, maximum.................. 288, 289
Roof rack............................................. 144
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 11
Version: 2.10.6
Index
S
Seat
Adjusting.................................... 63, 65
Correct driver's seat position........... 76
Folding the rear bench seat
forward........................................... 150
Removing/fitting the frontpassenger seat............................... 156
Removing/fitting the rear seat
backrest......................................... 152
Removing/fitting the rear seat
cushion........................................... 151
Seat belt
Adjusting the height.......................... 75
Display message....................... 76, 212
Fastening.......................................... 73
Warning lamp........................... 75, 228
Seat cushion
Removing (rear bench seat)............ 151
Seat heating.......................................... 69
Seat ventilation
Malfunction indicator lamp............. 222
Securing a load................................... 146
Selector lever
Positions........................................... 94
Service indicator................................ 191
Service products................................ 292
Brake fluid...................................... 300
Coolant........................................... 297
Windscreen washer fluid................. 300
Settings
Factory (on-board computer).......... 106
Setting the unit (on-board computer)
Speedometer.................................. 108
Sidebags................................................ 41
Side window
Fault............................................... 238
Side windows
Cleaning......................................... 194
Opening/closing............................... 84
resetting........................................... 85
Ski rack............................................... 144
Snow chains....................................... 182
Socket
Cockpit........................................... 163
Luggage compartment.................... 164
Spare wheel
Fitting............................................. 259
Storage location............................. 200
Technical data................................ 285
Speed
Technical data................................ 280
Speed limiter
Speedtronic.................................... 117
Speedometer
Digital speedometer (on-board
computer)....................................... 103
Setting the unit (on-board computer).............................................. 108
Speedtronic........................................ 117
Display message............................. 220
Permanent...................................... 120
Variable.......................................... 118
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)....................................................... 37
Display message............................. 211
Warning lamp........................... 37, 226
Standard display (on-board computer)................................................... 103
Station
see Radio
Status line (on-board computer)....... 100
Selecting the display....................... 108
Steering
Display message............................. 215
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL... 56
Steering wheel
Adjusting.......................................... 70
Buttons (on-board computer)............ 98
Stowage compartment...................... 159
Armrest (front)................................ 160
Armrest (under).............................. 161
Boxes under the driver's seat/
front-passenger seat....................... 161
11
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 12
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Centre console............................... 160
Glove compartment........................ 160
Luggage compartment.................... 161
Stowage space
Cup holder...................................... 144
Submenu (on-board computer)......... 107
Convenience................................... 108
Instrument cluster.......................... 107
Lighting........................................... 108
Time/date...................................... 107
Vehicle............................................ 108
Summer opening
see Convenience opening
Sun visor............................................. 162
Supplemental Restraint System
see SRS
Surround lighting
Switching on/off (on-board computer).............................................. 110
Switching off the alarm
ATA................................................... 57
T
Tailgate
Display message............................. 212
Opening/closing............................... 62
Tail lamps
changing......................................... 250
12
Tank
see Fuel tank
Tank capacity..................................... 292
Technical data
Acceleration................................... 281
Engine............................................. 278
Speed............................................. 280
Trailer loads.................................... 291
Tyres............................................... 283
Vehicle dimensions......................... 286
Vehicle weights............................... 286
Wheels............................................ 283
Telephone
see Mobile phone
Telephone compartment................... 160
Temperature
Coolant............................................. 97
Outside temperature......................... 98
Thermotronic
Malfunction indicator lamp............. 222
Third brake lamp
Display message............................. 217
Through-loading................................. 147
Tightening torque............................... 262
Time
Setting (on-board computer)........... 109
Setting the time (on-board computer).............................................. 109
TIREFIT kit
Using.............................................. 253
TopTether.............................................. 49
Total distance recorder............... 26, 100
Tow-away protection........................... 58
Towing................................................. 269
Towing eye
Fitting............................................. 269
Removing........................................ 270
Tow-starting........................................ 270
Trailer
7-pin connector.............................. 191
Display message............................. 216
Power supply.................................. 190
Trailer loads
Technical data................................ 291
Trailer tow hitch
Notes on care................................. 196
Trailer towing
Active parking assist....................... 127
Driving tips..................................... 188
Malfunction..................................... 240
Mounting dimensions..................... 290
Parktronic....................................... 123
Transmission
Display message............................. 209
Transmission output (maximum)
Telephone/two-way radio............... 275
Transport (vehicle)............................. 270
Trip computer
Menu (on-board computer)............. 112
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 13
Version: 2.10.6
Index
Trip meter............................. 26, 100, 102
Resetting.......................................... 98
Turn signal lamps
Display message............................. 217
Two-way radio
Installation...................................... 275
Tyre grip.............................................. 184
Tyre pressure ..................................... 178
Display message............................. 211
see Tyre pressure
Tyre pressure loss warning system. 179
Tyres
Direction of rotation....................... 177
General notes................................. 176
Technical data................................ 283
Tyre tread............................................ 178
U
Unladen weight.......................... 287, 288
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking...................... 241
From the inside (central unlocking
button).............................................. 61
V
Variable Speedtronic......................... 118
Vehicle
Emergency unlocking............. 241, 242
Individual settings (on-board computer).............................................. 106
Leaving parked up.......................... 240
Towing............................................ 269
Tow-starting.................................... 270
Transporting................................... 270
Vehicle battery................................... 263
Vehicle dimensions............................ 286
Vehicle electronics............................ 275
Vehicle identification number (VIN). 277
Vehicle identification plates............. 276
Vehicle tool kit................................... 200
Vehicle weights.................................. 286
W
Warning and indicator lamp
ABS (yellow).................................... 224
LIM (cruise control)......................... 116
LIM (variable Speedtronic).............. 118
Warning and indicator lamps
ESP®......................................... 56, 226
Warning signal
Audible........................................... 230
Warning triangle................................. 200
Washer fluid
Display message............................. 221
Washer fluid reservoir....................... 300
Filling capacity................................ 300
Wearing seat belts............................... 73
Wheel bolts
Tightening torque............................ 262
Wheel chock
Use................................................. 201
Wheels
General notes................................. 176
Interchanging.................................. 181
Technical data................................ 283
Windowbags......................................... 42
Windows
Cleaning......................................... 194
Cleaning the windscreen ............... 194
see Side windows
Windscreen
Cleaning ......................................... 194
Windscreen washer fluid................... 300
Topping up...................................... 175
Windscreen washer fluid reservoir. . 175
Windscreen washer system.............. 300
Windscreen wipers.............................. 83
Cleaning......................................... 194
Malfunction..................................... 237
Replacing the wiper blades............. 251
Winter diesel...................................... 170
Winter driving............................. 181, 182
13
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
Index
Winter tyres........................................ 181
Limiting the speed (on-board computer).............................................. 120
14
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 14
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 15
Version: 2.10.6
Introduction
Protection of the environment
Protection of the environment
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of integrated environmental protection.
The objectives are for the natural resources
which form the basis of our existence on
this planet to be used sparingly and in a
manner which takes the requirements of
both nature and humanity into account.
You too can help to protect the environment by operating your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuel consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tyre wear depend
on the following factors:
ROperating conditions of your vehicle
RYour
personal driving style
You can influence both factors.
You should bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions
RAvoid short trips as these increase fuel
consumption.
RMake
sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct.
RDo
not carry any unnecessary weight.
RKeep
an eye on the vehicle's fuel consumption.
RRemove
roof racks once you no longer
need them.
RA
regularly serviced vehicle will contribute to environmental protection. You
should therefore adhere to the service
intervals.
RAlways
have maintenance work carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Personal driving style
RDo not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
RDo not warm up the engine with the vehi-
cle stationary.
RDrive
carefully and maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front.
RAvoid
frequent, sudden acceleration.
RChange
gear in good time and use each
gear only up to 2/3 of its maximum engine
speed.
Returning used vehicles
Mercedes-Benz will take back your
Mercedes-Benz to dispose of it in an environmentally-responsible manner, in accordance
with the European Union (EU) End of Life
Vehicles Directive.
The End of Life Vehicles Directive applies to
vehicles of up to 3.5 t gross vehicle weight, in
accordance with national regulations. For
several years, Mercedes-Benz has been
meeting all the legal requirements for a
design which allows for recycling and re-use.
There is a network of return points and disassembly plants which can recycle your vehicle in an environmentally-responsible manner. The options for recycling vehicles and
parts are constantly being developed and
improved. This means that your MercedesBenz will also continue to meet even the
increased recycling quotas in the future in
good time. You can obtain further information
from your national Mercedes-Benz homepage
or your national hotline number.
RSwitch off the engine in stationary traffic.
Z
15
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 16
Version: 2.10.6
Introduction
Operating safety
Operating safety
G Risk of accident and injury
Safety notes
Work carried out incorrectly or impermissible modifications to the vehicle, for example cables laid under trim, can impair the
function of the safety systems. The safety
systems may no longer be able to protect
you or others as they are designed to do.
There is also a risk that you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident.
Have all work on and modifications to the
vehicle, such as installations or conversions, carried out at a qualified workshop.
G Risk of accident and injury
Always have work on the vehicle carried out
by a qualified specialist workshop. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems as well as maintenance
work must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. The workshop must have
the necessary specialist knowledge and
tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
G Risk of accident and injury
Some safety systems only function while
the engine is running. Therefore, do not
switch the engine off when driving. Otherwise, the safety systems in your vehicle
may no longer function correctly and
thereby not provide you or others with the
intended degree of protection. There is also
a risk that you could lose control of the
vehicle and cause an accident.
G Risk of accident
A heavy impact to the underbody, tyres or
wheels, for example when bottoming out on
rough terrain or driving over an obstacle at
high speed, could damage your vehicle. As
a result, you could cause an accident. This
also applies to vehicles which are equipped
with underbody protection.
For this reason, drive slowly over obstacles,
avoid bottoming out the vehicle in rough
terrain and, if necessary, have your vehicle
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of accident
If work on electronic equipment and its
software is carried out incorrectly, the
16
equipment could stop functioning. The
electronic systems are networked via interfaces. Tampering with these electronic systems could cause malfunctions in systems
which have not been modified. Such malfunctions can seriously compromise the
vehicle’s operating safety and your own
safety as well.
Have all work on and modifications to electronic components carried out at a qualified
workshop.
Vehicle registration
Mercedes-Benz may ask its Service Centres
to carry out technical inspections on certain
vehicles to improve their quality or safety.
If you did not purchase your vehicle from an
authorised specialist dealer and your vehicle
has never been inspected at a MercedesBenz Service Centre, it is possible that your
vehicle is not registered in your name with
Mercedes-Benz. Mercedes-Benz can only
inform you about vehicle checks if it has your
registration data.
It is advisable to register your vehicle with a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 17
Version: 2.10.6
Introduction
Operating safety
Inform Mercedes-Benz as soon as possible
about any change in address or vehicle ownership.
Correct use
Observe the following information when using
your vehicle:
RThe safety notes in this manual
RThe "Technical data" section in this manual
RNational
road traffic regulations
RNational
road traffic licensing regulations
G Risk of injury
Various warning stickers are affixed to your
vehicle. Their purpose is to draw your attention, and the attention of others, to various
dangers. Therefore, do not remove any
warning stickers unless the sticker clearly
states that you may do so.
If you remove the warning stickers, you or
others could be injured by failing to recognise certain dangers.
Z
17
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
18
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 18
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 19
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Exterior view .......................................
Cockpit .................................................
Instrument cluster ..............................
Multi-function steering wheel ............
Centre console ....................................
Overhead control panel ......................
Door control panel ..............................
20
22
26
30
31
33
34
19
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
At a glance
Exterior view
Exterior view
20
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 20
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 21
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Exterior view
Function
1
2
3
4
Page
7
Luggage compartment
Spare wheel
201
Vehicle tool kit
200
Rear window heating
140
Opening and closing the
tailgate
61
Fuel filler flap
168
Fuel requirements
168
5
Opening and closing the
doors
60
6
Exterior mirrors
71
* optional
Function
8
9
Page
Demisting the windscreen
139
Cleaning the windows
Function
a
Page
Opening the bonnet
171
194
Engine oil
172
Panorama roof*
142
Coolant
175
Panorama louvred sliding
sunroof*
b
Front lights
245
142
c
Fitting the front towing eye
268
Windscreen wiper operation
83
d
Tyres and wheels
176
Cleaning the wiper blades
194
Checking the tyre pressure
178
Replacing the wiper blades
251
Flat tyre, fitting the spare
wheel
253
e
Fitting the rear towing eye
268
f
Rear lights
245
21
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
At a glance
Cockpit
Cockpit
Left-hand-drive vehicles
22
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 22
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 23
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
1
Opens the bonnet
2
Combination switch:
79
• main-beam headlamps
80
• turn signals
79
• windscreen wipers
83
• rear window wiper
83
3
171
Cruise control lever*:
• Cruise control*
115
• Speedtronic*
117
* optional
Function
Page
4
Multi-function steering
wheel
98
5
Instrument cluster
26
6
Horn
7
Parktronic* warning display
121
8
Overhead control panel
33
Function
Page
9
Opens the glove compartment
a
Centre console
31
b
Ignition lock
62
c
Adjusts the steering wheel
70
d
Adjusts the headlamp
range
80
e
Light switch
77
f
Door control panel
34
160
23
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
At a glance
Cockpit
Right-hand-drive vehicles
24
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 24
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 25
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
Function
Page
1
Overhead control panel
33
5
2
Parktronic* warning display
Multi-function steering
wheel
98
121
6
Instrument cluster
26
3
Combination switch:
79
7
Horn
• main-beam headlamps
80
8
Opens the bonnet
• turn signals
79
9
• windscreen wipers
83
a
• rear window wiper
83
4
Function
Page
b
Adjusts the headlamp
range
80
c
Ignition lock
62
d
Adjusts the steering wheel
70
171
e
Centre console
31
Door control panel
34
f
Light switch
77
Opens the glove compartment
160
Cruise control lever*:
• Cruise control*
115
• Speedtronic*
117
* optional
25
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster, kilometres
26
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 26
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 27
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Function
1
Page
Function
Page
1
LIM indicator lamp*
115
d
2
ESP® (Electronic Stability
Program) warning lamp
Engine diagnostics warning
lamp
227
226
e
Reserve fuel warning lamp
229
3
Speedometer
f
4
Turn signal indicator lamp
Fuel filler cap location: the
fuel filter cap is to the rear
on the right
5
Multi-function display,
upper section
79
100
6
Trip distance
98
7
Total distance
103
8
Turn signal indicator lamp
79
9
ABS (anti-lock braking system) warning lamp
224
a
Diesel engine: preglow indicator lamp
88
b
Rev counter
98
c
SRS (Supplemental
Restraint System) warning
lamp
m
Depending on the setting in
the on-board computer:
Page
108
• Outside temperature1
• Digital speedometer
g
Fuel gauge
h
Main-beam indicator lamp
80
j
Dipped-beam indicator
lamp
78
k
Seat belt warning lamp
228
l
Clock
Speedtronic*: stored limit
speed
Function
98
117
n
Rear window wiper
switched on
o
Multi-function display,
lower section
p
AUTOTRONIC*: drive program display
94
q
AUTOTRONIC*: selector
lever position display
94
r
Brake system warning lamp
s
Reset button
97
t
Coolant temperature gauge
97
83
100
226
226
Vehicles for United Kingdom: the speed in km/h is always shown instead of the outside temperature.
* optional
27
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster, miles
28
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 28
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 29
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Instrument cluster
Function
2
Page
1
LIM indicator lamp*
115
2
ESP® warning lamp
226
3
Speedometer
4
Turn signal indicator lamp
5
Multi-function display,
upper section
79
Function
Page
d
Engine diagnostics warning
lamp
227
e
Reserve fuel warning lamp
229
f
Fuel filler cap location: the
fuel filter cap is to the rear
on the right
100
g
Fuel gauge
Trip distance
98
h
Main-beam indicator lamp
80
7
Total distance
103
j
Dipped-beam indicator
lamp
78
k
Seat belt warning lamp
228
l
Clock
Turn signal indicator lamp
9
ABS warning lamp
a
Diesel engine: preglow indicator lamp
88
b
Rev counter
98
c
SRS warning lamp
79
224
Speedtronic*: stored limit
speed
m
Depending on the setting in
the on-board computer:
Page
108
• Outside temperature2
• Digital speedometer
6
8
Function
98
117
226
n
Rear window wiper
switched on
o
Multi-function display,
lower section
p
AUTOTRONIC*: drive program display
94
q
AUTOTRONIC*: selector
lever position display
94
r
Brake system warning lamp
s
Reset button
97
t
Coolant temperature gauge
97
83
100
226
Vehicles for United Kingdom: the speed in km/h is always shown instead of the outside temperature.
* optional
29
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 30
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Multi-function steering wheel
Multi-function steering wheel
Function
1
Multi-function display
2
æ• selects submenus in the
Settings menu
• changes values
• adjusts the volume
3
4
s t Accepts or
rejects/or ends a call*
Page
Function
100
113
j k Press briefly:
scrolls back and forth in a
menu
101
Audio 5*: in the Audio*
menu, selects an audio
track or, depending on the
setting, a stored station or
the next/previous station
103
5
30
Page
Audio 20*, Audio 50 APS*
and COMAND APS*: in the
Audio*/DVD* menu,
selects a stored station, an
audio track or a video
scene*.
103
In the Telephone* menu,
switches to the phone book
and selects a name or
phone number
114
j k Press and
hold (Audio 20* only),
Audio 50 APS* and
COMAND APS*): In the
Audio*/DVD* menu,
selects the next/previous
station, selects an audio
track using rapid scrolling
103
In the Telephone* menu,
starts rapid scrolling
through the telephone book
114
è ÿ Selects menus:
scrolls back and forth
101
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 31
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Centre console
Centre console
Upper section
Function
1
Switches the hazard warning lamps on/off
80
2
5 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF warning lamp*
45
3
Controls COMAND APS*
and the audio system* –
see the respective operating instructions
4
Controls Heatmatic, the airconditioning system* or
Thermotronic*
129
Switches the rear window
heating on/off
140
Activates/deactivates the
seat heating* for the righthand seat
69
6
Activates/deactivates the
ECO start/stop function*
127
7
Primes/deactivates the
interior motion sensor*/
tow-away protection*
58
5
* optional
Page
Function
8
Deactivates/activates
Parktronic*
9
Activates/deactivates the
seat heating* for the lefthand seat
Page
122
69
31
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 32
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Centre console
Lower section
Function
1
2
Opens the stowage compartment
160
Socket
163
Opens the ashtray*
162
Cigarette lighter
163
Manual transmission: gear
lever
92
AUTOTRONIC*: selector
lever
94
3
Selects the drive program*
94
4
Parking brake
90
5
Adjusts the armrest* and
opens the stowage compartment*
67
Opens the stowage compartment/telephone compartment*
160
Cup holder
144
6
7
32
Page
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 33
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
1
£ To switch the rear
interior lighting on/off
82
2
¥ To switch the automatic interior lighting control on/off
82
a To open/close the
panorama louvred sliding
sunroof*
142
4
X To switch the righthand reading lamp on/off
82
5
Rear-view mirror
70
6
X To switch the lefthand reading lamp on/off
82
3
7
ð To switch the front
interior lighting on/off
82
The arrangement of the controls may vary,
depending on the equipment in the vehicle.
Z
* optional
33
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 34
Version: 2.10.6
At a glance
Door control panel
Door control panel
Function
1
r Adjusts the exterior
mirrors
71
2
Z Folds the exterior mirrors in/out*
71
3
& Selects the right exterior mirror
71
4
= Opens/closes the
front side windows
84
5
= 5-door vehicle:
opens/closes* the rear
side windows
84
5-door vehicle: activates/
deactivates the override
feature for the rear power
side windows*
54
7
k Unlocks the vehicle
61
8
j Locks the vehicle
61
6
34
Page
Function
Page
9
Opens the door
61
a
% Selects the left exterior mirror
71
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 35
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety .................................. 36
Driving safety systems ....................... 55
Anti-theft systems .............................. 57
35
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 36
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Occupant safety
Notes on occupant safety
Seat belts, together with belt tensioners, belt
force limiters and airbags, are coordinated
restraint systems. They reduce the risk of
injury in defined accident situations and
thereby increase occupant safety. However,
seat belts and airbags generally do not protect against objects penetrating the vehicle
from the outside.
To ensure that the restraint systems can
deliver their full potential protection, you
should ensure that:
Rthe
seat and head restraint are adjusted
properly (Y page 63)
Rthe
seat belt has been fastened properly
(Y page 73)
Rthe
airbags can inflate properly if they are
deployed (Y page 39)
Rthe
steering wheel is adjusted properly
(Y page 70)
Rthe
fied
restraint systems have not been modi-
i An airbag increases the protection of
vehicle occupants wearing a seat belt.
However, airbags are only an additional
36
restraint system which complements, but
does not replace, the seat belt. All vehicle
occupants must wear their seat belt correctly at all times, even if the vehicle is
equipped with airbags. This is because - on
the one hand - airbags are not deployed in
all types of accident, as in some situations
airbag deployment would not increase the
protection afforded to vehicle occupants,
provided they are wearing their seat belt
correctly. On the other hand, airbag deployment only provides increased protection if
the seat belt is worn correctly because:
Rthe seat belt helps to keep the vehicle
occupant in the best position in relation
to the airbag
Rfor
example, in a head-on collision, the
seat belt can more adequately prevent
the occupant from being propelled
towards the force of the impact, and is
thus better suited to prevent injury
Therefore, in accident situations where an
airbag is deployed, it only provides protection in addition to the seat belt if the seat
belt is being worn correctly.
G Risk of accident and injury
Always have maintenance work carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop which
has the necessary specialist knowledge
and tools to carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose.
In particular, work relevant to safety or on
safety-related systems must be carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop. If this
work is not carried out correctly, the operating safety of your vehicle may be affected. There is a risk of an accident and injury.
G Risk of injury
The restraint system may not work as intended if the following components have been
modified or work on these components has
not been performed correctly:
Rrestraint
system, consisting of the seat
belts and anchorages, belt tensioners,
belt force limiters, airbags
Rwiring
Rnetworked
electronic systems
Airbags or belt tensioners could then fail,
e.g. in the event of an accident in which the
deceleration force would normally be high
enough to trigger the systems, or they
could be triggered unintentionally. Never
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 37
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
carry out any modifications on the restraint
systems.
Never tamper with electronic components
and their software.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
The SRS reduces the risk of occupants coming into contact with the vehicle's interior in
the event of an accident. It can also reduce
the forces to which occupants are subjected
during an accident.
The SRS consists of:
RThe
1 warning lamp
Rbelt
tensioners
Rbelt
force limiters
Rairbags
The 1warning lamp
The SRS functions are checked regularly
when you turn on the ignition and when the
engine is running. Malfunctions can therefore
be detected in good time.
The 1 warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out no later than a few seconds
after the engine is started.
G Risk of injury
If SRS is malfunctioning, individual systems
may be activated unintentionally or not be
deployed in the event of an accident with
heavy braking.
A malfunction has occurred if the 1
warning lamp:
Rdoes not light up when you switch on the
ignition
Rdoes not go out after the engine has been
running for a few seconds
Rlights up again once the engine is running
In this case, have SRS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Triggering of belt tensioners, belt force
limiters and airbags
In the event of a collision, the sensor in the
airbag control unit evaluates important physical data such as duration, direction and force
of the vehicle deceleration or acceleration.
Based on the evaluation of this data and
depending on the vehicle's rate of longitudinal deceleration in a collision, in the first
stage the airbag control unit pre-emptively
triggers the belt tensioners.
The front airbags are only deployed if there is
an even higher rate of vehicle deceleration in
a longitudinal direction.
Your vehicle has adaptive, dual stage front
airbags. When the first activation threshold is
reached, the front airbag is filled with enough
propellant gas to reduce the risk of injuries.
The front airbag is only fully inflated if a second threshold is reached within a few milliseconds, due to the control unit having detected further deceleration.
Criteria for triggering belt tensioners and
airbags
In the first stage of a collision, the airbag control unit evaluates the duration and direction
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in
order to determine whether it is necessary to
trigger the belt tensioner and/or airbag.
The belt tensioner and airbag triggering
thresholds are variable and are adapted to the
rate of deceleration of the vehicle. This process is pre-emptive in nature as the airbag
must be deployed during – and not at the end
of – the collision.
i Airbags are not deployed in all types of
accidents. They are controlled by complex
sensor technology and evaluation logic.
This process is pre-emptive in nature as
37
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 38
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
airbag deployment must take place during
the impact and must be adapted to provide
calculated, additional protection for the
vehicle occupants. Not all airbags are
deployed in an accident.
The different airbag systems work independently of each other. However, the
deployment of each individual system will
depend on the type of accident determined
by the control system in the first stages of
the collision (head-on collision, side impact
and overturn) and the extent of the accident (in particular, the vehicle's rate of
deceleration or acceleration).
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are basically determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe
collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehi-
cle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided, e.g. the other vehicle
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
38
decisive role in the deployment of an airbag,
nor do they provide an indication of it.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly,
e. g. on the bonnet or the wing, without an
airbag being deployed. This is the case if only
parts which are relatively easily deformed are
affected and the necessary deceleration does
not occur. Conversely, airbags may be
deployed even though the vehicle suffers only
minor deformations. This is the case if, for
example, very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are affected and sufficient deceleration occurs as a result.
Belt tensioners, belt force limiters
The front seat belts and the outer seat belts
in the rear are equipped with belt tensioners.
If the seat belt is also equipped with a belt
force limiter, the force exerted by the seat
belt on the seat occupant is reduced.
Belt tensioners tighten the seat belts in an
accident, pulling them close against the body.
i Belt tensioners do not correct incorrect
seat positions or incorrectly fastened seat
belts.
Belt tensioners do not pull occupants back
towards the backrest.
The front belt force limiters are synchronised
with the front airbags, which distribute the
forces exerted by the belt force limiters on
the occupant over a greater area.
When the ignition is switched on, the belt tensioner is triggered:
Ronly if the restraint systems are operational
(the 1 warning lamp lights up after the
ignition is switched on and goes out once
the engine is running) (Y page 37)
Rin
the event of a head-on or rear-end collision if the vehicle decelerates or accelerates rapidly in a longitudinal direction during the initial stages of impact
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that escapes
does not generally constitute a health hazard.
The 1 warning lamp lights up.
G Risk of injury
If the seat belt tensioners have been triggered, they provide no additional protection in the event of another accident. Therefore, have belt tensioners which have been
triggered replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 39
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Comply with safety regulations when disposing of belt tensioners. Any MercedesBenz Service Centre can provide details of
these regulations.
Airbags
Airbag deployment slows down and restricts
the movement of the vehicle occupant.
If the airbags are deployed, you will hear a
bang and a small amount of powder may also
be released. Only in rare cases will the bang
affect your hearing. The powder that escapes
does not generally constitute a health hazard.
The 1 warning lamp lights up.
The SRS/AIRBAG identification indicates the
location of the airbags.
G Risk of injury
Airbags provide additional protection; they
are not, however, a substitute for seat
belts.
Observe the following notes to reduce the
risk of serious or even fatal injury if an airbag is deployed:
Rall vehicle occupants — in particular preg-
nant women — must wear their seat belt
correctly at all times and lean back
* optional
against the backrest, which should be
positioned as close to the vertical as possible. The head restraint must support
the back of the head at about eye level.
Ralways
secure children less than 1.50 m
tall or under 12 years of age in suitable
child restraint systems.
Rall
vehicle occupants must select a seat
position that is as far away from the airbag as possible. The driver's seat position must allow the vehicle to be driven
safely. The driver's chest should be as far
away from the middle of the driver's front
airbag cover as possible.
Rmove
the front-passenger seat as far
back as possible, especially if a child is
secured in a child restraint system on the
seat.
Rvehicle
occupants – in particular, children – must not lean their head on the
area of the window in which a sidebag or
head/thorax airbag* is deployed.
RRearward-facing
child restraint systems
must not be fitted to the front-passenger
seat unless the front-passenger front airbag has been disabled. The frontpassenger front airbag of a vehicle fitted
with automatic child seat recognition* is
only disabled when a child restraint system with automatic child seat recognition is fitted to the front-passenger seat.
The 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
warning lamp must be constantly lit.
If the front-passenger seat of your vehicle
does not have automatic child seat recognition*, or your rearward-facing child
restraint system does not have such a
feature, children must be secured in a
child restraint system on a suitable seat
in the rear. If you secure a forward-facing
child restraint system to the frontpassenger seat, you must move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible.
Rmake
sure there are no heavy or sharpedged objects in pockets of clothing.
Rdo
not lean forwards, e.g. over the cover
of the driver's front airbag, particularly
when the vehicle is in motion.
Rdo
not put your feet on the dashboard.
Ronly
hold the steering wheel by the rim.
This allows the airbag to inflate fully. You
could be injured if the airbag is deployed
and you are holding the inside of the
steering wheel.
39
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 40
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Rdo
not lean on the doors from inside the
vehicle.
Rmake
sure that there are no people, animals or objects between the vehicle
occupants and the area of deployment of
the airbag.
Rdo
not place any objects between the
seat backrest and the door.
Rdo
not hang any hard objects, for example coat hangers, on the grab handles or
coat hooks.
Rdo
not attach accessories, e.g. cup holders, to the doors.
It is not possible to rule out a risk of injuries
caused by an airbag due to the high speed
at which the airbag is required to deploy.
G Risk of injury
The airbag's functionality can only be guaranteed if the following parts are not covered and no badges or stickers are
attached to them:
Rpadded
steering wheel boss
Rfront-passenger
Router
Rside
40
front airbag cover
side of front seats
panel next to the rear seat backrest
G Risk of injury
When an airbag deploys, a small amount of
powder is released. The powder may cause
short-term breathing difficulties to persons
suffering from asthma or other pulmonary
conditions.
In order to prevent potential breathing difficulties you should leave the vehicle as
soon as it is safe to do so. You can also open
the window to allow fresh air to enter the
interior. The powder does not constitute a
health hazard and does not indicate that
there is a fire in the vehicle.
G Risk of injury
The airbag parts are hot after the airbag has
been deployed. Do not touch them, otherwise you may burn yourself.
Have the airbags checked at a qualified
specialist workshop. Otherwise, occupants
are not protected by the airbags in the
event of another accident.
Front airbags
The front airbags are designed to increase
protection for the driver's and frontpassenger head and chest.
The driver's front airbag and front-passenger
front airbag are deployed:
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
Rif
the system determines that airbag
deployment can offer additional protection
to that provided by the seat belt
Rif
the seat belt is fastened
Rindependently
cle
of other airbags in the vehi-
Rif
the vehicle overturns, but only if the system detects high vehicle deceleration in a
longitudinal direction
1 Driver's front airbag
2 Front-passenger front airbag
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 41
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Driver's front airbag 1 deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front airbag
2 deploys in front of and above the glove
compartment.
On vehicles with automatic child seat recognition in the front-passenger seat*, frontpassenger front airbag 2 is only deployed if
the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp in the centre console is not lit
(Y page 45). This means that there is not a
child restraint system with automatic child
seat recognition* fitted to the frontpassenger seat or that a child restraint system with automatic child seat recognition*
has been fitted to the front-passenger seat
incorrectly.
Head/thorax airbags, rear sidebags*
i If you have specified windowbags* as
optional equipment, the front seats of the
vehicle will be equipped with sidebags
instead of head/thorax airbags.
G Risk of injury
If you wish to use seat covers, MercedesBenz recommends that, for safety reasons,
you only use seat covers that have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
* optional
The seat covers must have a special tear
seam for head/thorax airbags. Otherwise,
a head/thorax airbag cannot deploy correctly and would fail to provide the intended
protection in the event of an accident.
Appropriate seat covers can be obtained
from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The purpose of head/thorax airbag deployment is to enhance the level of protection for
the head and thorax (but not the arms) of the
vehicle occupants on the side of the vehicle
on which the impact occurs.
The purpose of rear sidebag deployment is to
enhance the level of protection for the thorax
(but not the head, neck or arms) of the vehicle
occupants on the side of the vehicle on which
the impact occurs.
1 Front head/thorax airbag
2 Rear sidebag in the side trim next to the
backrest
The front head/thorax airbags or rear sidebags inflate next to the outer seat cushion.
Front head/thorax airbag 1 or rear sidebags
2 are deployed:
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of lateral vehicle deceleration or acceleration, e.g. in a side impact
Rindependently
of the seat belt use
Rindependently
of the front airbags
Rindependently
of the belt tensioners
Z
41
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 42
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Windowbags*
The purpose of the windowbags is to enhance
the level of protection for the head (but not
chest or arms) of the vehicle occupants on
the side of the vehicle on which the impact
occurs.
The windowbags are integrated into the side
of the roof frame On 5-door vehicles, they are
located between the front door (A-pillar) and
the rear door (C-pillar). On 3-door vehicles,
they are located between the front door (Apillar) and the rear inner wing (C-pillar).
Windowbags 1 are deployed:
i If you have specified windowbags* as
The active head restraints are designed to
increase protection to the driver's and frontpassenger's head and neck. In the event of a
rear-end collision the force exerted by the
driver's or front-passenger's chest causes
the head restraints on the driver's and frontpassenger seats to be moved forwards. This
provides better head support.
optional equipment, the front seats of the
vehicle will be equipped with sidebags
instead of head/thorax airbags.
Rat
the start of an accident with a high rate
of vehicle acceleration or deceleration in a
lateral direction
Ron
the side on which an impact occurs
Rindependently
of the front airbags
Rregardless
of whether the front-passenger
seat is occupied
Active head restraints
G Risk of injury
Do not secure any objects (e.g. coat hangers) on the head restraint rods. Otherwise,
the active head restraints may not function
correctly and could fail to provide the intended protection in the event of an accident.
Children in the vehicle
If a child is travelling in your vehicle, secure
the child using a child restraint system which
is appropriate to the size and age of the child
and recommended for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. You should fit the restraint system to a
suitable rear seat. Make sure that the child is
secured in a child restraint system throughout the trip.
You can obtain information about the correct
child restraint system from any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products to clean child restraint systems.
Information about this can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. Children could injure
themselves on parts of the vehicle. They
could also be seriously or even fatally
injured by prolonged exposure to extreme
heat or cold.
Do not expose the child restraint system to
direct sunlight. Parts of the child restraint
1 Windowbag
42
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 43
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
system could heat up and the child could
burn itself on them.
If a child opens a door, the child or other
persons could be injured as a result. The
child could get out and be injured in the
process or be injured by a passing vehicle.
G Risk of injury
An unsecured or incorrectly positioned load
increases the risk of injury to the child in
the event of:
Ran
accident
Ra
braking manoeuvre
Ra
sudden change of direction
Do not carry heavy or hard objects inside
the vehicle unless they are secured. You
will find further information under "Loading
guidelines" in the index.
Child restraint systems
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use the child restraint systems listed on
(Y page 47).
* optional
G Risk of injury
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Rchildren
less than 1.50 m tall and under
twelve years of age must always be
secured in special child restraint systems
on a suitable vehicle seat. This is necessary because the seat belts are not
designed for children of this size.
RDo
not secure children less than 1.50 m
tall or under twelve years of age on the
front-passenger seat. Exception: the
child is secured in a vehicle with automatic child seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat* and is secured in a child
restraint system with automatic child
seat recognition.
RIf
you secure a forward-facing child
restraint system to the front-passenger
seat, you must move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible.
Rchildren
must never travel sitting on the
lap of another occupant. Due to the
forces occurring in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident, it would not be possible to
restrain the child. The child could be
thrown against parts of the vehicle interior and be seriously or even fatally
injured.
G Risk of injury
The child restraint system cannot perform
its protective function if is not correctly fitted to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be restrained in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident. This may lead to serious or even
fatal injuries. For this reason, when fitting
a child restraint system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the
correct use of the child restraint system.
Child restraint systems should be fitted to
the rear seats. Children are generally better
protected there.
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion.
Never place objects, e.g. a cushion, under
the child restraint system.
Only use child restraint systems with their
original covers. Only replace damaged covers with genuine Mercedes-Benz covers.
For safety reasons, you should only use
child restraint systems which have been
43
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 44
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
rearward-facing child restraint system on
a suitable rear seat.
approved for use in Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
Vehicles with a through-loading feature* in
the rear seat backrest: do not fit a rearward-facing child restraint system on the
centre rear seat.
Ralways move the front-passenger seat to
the rearmost position if you secure a
child in a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat.
The front-passenger front airbag is not disabled:
Child seat on the front-passenger seat
Ron
Warning symbol for a rearward-facing child
restraint system
G Risk of injury
If the front-passenger front airbag is not
disabled:
Ra child secured in a child restraint system
Warning on the front-passenger sun visor
on the front-passenger seat could be
seriously and even fatally injured by the
front-passenger front airbag deploying.
This is especially a risk if the child is in
the immediate vicinity of the frontpassenger front airbag when it deploys.
Ra
child must never be secured on the
front-passenger seat in a rearward-facing
child restraint system. Only secure a
44
vehicles without automatic child seat
recognition in the front-passenger seat*
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat rec-
ognition on the front-passenger seat* if
there is no child restraint system with
automatic child seat recognition fitted to
the front-passenger seat.
Ron vehicles with automatic child seat rec-
ognition on the front-passenger seat* if
the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning lamp is not lit.
To draw attention to this danger, there is an
appropriate warning sticker on the dashboard as well as on both sides of the sun
visor on the front-passenger side.
Information about recommended child
restraint systems is available at any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 45
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Automatic child seat recognition on the
front-passenger seat*
If your vehicle does not have automatic child
seat recognition on the front-passenger seat,
this is indicated by a special sticker. The
sticker is affixed to the side of the dashboard
on the front-passenger side. It is visible when
you open the front-passenger door.
G Risk of injury
If the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning lamp does not light up when the child
restraint system is fitted, the frontpassenger front airbag has not been disabled. If the front-passenger front airbag is
deployed, the child could be seriously or
even fatally injured.
Proceed as follows:
Rdo
not use a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger
seat.
Rfit
a rearward-facing child restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
or
Ronly
1 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp
The front-passenger seat sensor system for
child restraint systems detects whether a
special Mercedes-Benz child seat with automatic child seat recognition has been fitted.
In such cases, 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF indicator lamp 1 lights up. The frontpassenger airbag is deactivated.
* optional
use a forward-facing child restraint
system on the front-passenger seat and
move the front-passenger seat to its rearmost position.
Rhave the automatic child seat recognition
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
To ensure that the automatic child seat recognition on the front-passenger seat functions correctly, never place objects (such
as a cushion) under the child restraint system. The entire base of the child restraint
system must always rest on the seat cushion. An incorrectly fitted child restraint system cannot perform its intended protective
function in the event of an accident, and
could lead to injuries.
i The windowbag*, the head/thorax airbag
and the belt tensioner for the frontpassenger seat are still active even if the
front-passenger seat front airbag has been
disabled by the automatic child seat recognition.
G Risk of injury
Do not place items of electronic equipment
on the front-passenger seat, e.g.:
Rlaptops,
Rmobile
when switched on
phones
Rcards
with transponders, e.g. ski passes
or access cards
Signals from electronic equipment can
cause interference in the automatic child
seat recognition sensor system. This could
lead to a system malfunction. This may
cause the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
warning lamp to light up without there
being a child seat with automatic child seat
recognition fitted. This means that the
45
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 46
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
front-passenger airbag does not deploy
during an accident. It is also possible that
the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp will not light up briefly if you turn the
key in the ignition lock to position 2.
Suitable positioning of the child restraint system
Weight categories and ages
Child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat
Group 0: up to 10 kg;
up to approx. 9 months
Vehicles with automatic child
Universal or as recommended
seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat*: as recommended3
Universal or as recommended
Universal or as recommended
Universal or as recommended
Group 0+: up to 13 kg;
up to approx. 18 months
Group I: 9 to 18 kg;
between approx. 8 months and 4
years
Universal4 or as recommended
Child restraint system on the Child restraint system on the
left-hand and right-hand rear centre rear seat
seats
Group II/III: 15 to 36 kg;
between approx. 3½ and 12 years
3
4
Only use child restraint systems with automatic child seat recognition.
Move the front-passenger seat to its rearmost and uppermost position.
46
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 47
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
"Universal" category child restraint systems
can be recognised by their orange approval
label.
Example of an approval label on the child restraint
system
Recommended child restraint systems
Weight categories and
ages
Manufacturer
Type
Approval number
Daimler order num- Automatic child seat
ber
recognition
Group 0: up to 10 kg;
up to approx. 9 months
Britax-Römer
BABY SAFE
PLUS5
E1 03 301146
A 000 970 10 00
Yes
B6 6 86 8224
no6
A 000 970 10 00
Yes
B6 6 86 8224
No6
BABY SAFE ISOFIX PLUS
Group 0+: up to 13 kg;
up to approx. 18 months
Britax-Römer
BABY SAFE
PLUS5
E1 03 301146
BABY SAFE ISOFIX PLUS
5
6
Z
Move the front-passenger seat to the highest position.
The child restraint system may only be fitted to the left-hand and right-hand rear seats.
47
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 48
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Weight categories and
ages
Manufacturer
Type
Approval number
Daimler order num- Automatic child seat
ber
recognition
Group I: 9 to 18 kg;
between approx. 8
months and 4 years
Britax-Römer
DUO PLUS5
E1 03 301133
A 000 970 11 00
Yes
A 000 970 16 00
No7
A 000 970 12 00
Yes
A 000 970 17 00
No7
Category II/III: 15 to 36 kg Britax-Römer
between approx. 3½ and
12 years
ISOFIX child seat securing system in the
rear compartment
ISOFIX is a standardised securing system for
specially-designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. Securing rings for two child
restraint systems are fitted on the left and
right rear seats.
G Risk of injury
A child restraint system secured by the ISOFIX child seat securing system does not
provide sufficient protection for children
weighing more than 22 kg. For this reason,
do not secure children weighing more than
22 kg in a child restraint system secured by
the ISOFIX child seat securing system. If
5
7
KID5
E1 03 301148
the child weighs more than 22 kg, secure
the child restraint system using a lap-shoulder belt.
G Risk of injury
The child restraint system cannot perform
its protective function if is not correctly fitted to a suitable vehicle seat. The child cannot be restrained in the event of a sudden
change of direction, heavy braking or an
accident. This may lead to serious or even
fatal injuries. For this reason, when fitting
a child restraint system, observe the manufacturer's installation instructions and the
correct use of the child restraint system.
On the rear seats, only use child restraint
systems with an ISOFIX child seat securing
system which have been recommended for
use in Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
An incorrectly fitted child restraint system
could come loose and seriously or even
fatally injure the child or other vehicle occupants. When fitting the child restraint system, make sure that it is engaged in the
securing rings on both sides.
G Risk of injury
Please note that child restraint systems
cannot provide a protective function if they
or their retaining systems are damaged or
subjected to a load in an accident. This
Move the front-passenger seat to the highest position.
For child restraint systems without automatic child seat recognition, move the front-passenger seat to the rearmost position.
48
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 49
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
could result in serious or even fatal injuries
to the secured child in the event of an accident, heavy braking or a sudden change in
direction.
For this reason, have child restraint systems and their anchorages which have
been damaged or subjected to a load in an
accident checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
TopTether
TopTether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured
with ISOFIX and the front-passenger seat. It
helps reduce the risk of injury even further.
Both TopTether anchorages are attached to
the rear of the rear seat backrests.
! When fitting the child restraint system,
4 TopTether anchorage
5 TopTether hook*
make sure that the seat belt for the middle
seat does not become trapped. It could
otherwise be damaged.
6 TopTether belt* for the ISOFIX child
restraint system
Move head restraint 1 upwards.
Vehicles with a luggage compartment
cover*: release rear seat backrest 2
(Y page 150) and fold it forwards slightly.
X All: guide TopTether belt* 6 under head
restraint 1 between the two head restraint
rods.
X Fit TopTether hook* 5 into TopTether
anchorage 4 on the back of rear seat
backrest 2.
X
X
1 Head restraints
2 Rear seat backrests
3 Luggage compartment cover*
4 TopTether anchorages
1 Securing rings
Z
* optional
49
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 50
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Vehicles with a luggage compartment
cover*: make sure you do not route the belt
across luggage compartment cover 3.
X Vehicles with a luggage compartment
cover*: swing back rear seat backrest 2
until it engages.
The red lock verification indicator is no longer visible (Y page 151).
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the rear seat backrest is
fully locked. The red lock verification indicators on the left and right should no longer
be visible. If they are, the rear seat backrests are not locked. If this is the case, occupants could be injured in the event of an
accident, e.g. by objects being thrown forwards from the luggage compartment.
All: move head restraints 1 slightly down
again if necessary (Y page 66). Make sure
that you do not interfere with the correct
routing of TopTether belt* 6.
X Install the ISOFIX child restraint system
with TopTether*. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions.
X
50
Integrated child seat*
The child seats are integrated into the right
and left-hand sides of the seats of the rear
bench seat. They comply with the legal
requirements of ECE Regulation 44.03.
Mercedes-Benz recommends the integrated
child seat for children from approximately
two to twelve years of age or with a body
weight of 12.5 kg to 36 kg.
For children between approximately two and
four years of age or weighing between
approximately 12.5 kg and 22 kg, you must
also use a padded table* which has been specially approved for the integrated child seat
(Y page 51).
RReplace an integrated child seat that has
been damaged or subjected to a heavy
load as the result of an accident.
RBe
aware that children under two years
of age require a different child restraint
system. Information about other child
restraint systems is available from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
RThe
rear seat backrest in the vehicle
must be securely locked in position.
Folding out the child seat
G Risk of injury
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
RDo
not modify the integrated child seat.
RWhen
the child seat is occupied, adjust
the head restraint to a position at which
the back of the child's head is supported
by the centre of the head restraint at
about eye level.
1 Release catch
2 Hook
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 51
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Press release catch 1.
The child seat folds upwards.
X Push the child seat back to the stop so that
it engages.
X
Fastening a child's seat belt
G Risk of injury
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Pull the belt smoothly from the inertia reel.
Guide the lower lap section of the belt
through hook 2.
X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt
buckle.
X Make sure that the belt:
Ris routed as low as possible across the
pelvic area, in front of the hips
X
Ris
tightened across the lap by pulling
upwards on the child's shoulder belt
RThe shoulder belt section of the seat belt
must be routed across the middle of the
child's shoulder – never across the
child's neck – and be pulled tight against
the child's chest. The lap section of the
seat belt must be routed across the
child's pelvis – not across the abdomen
– and be pulled tight against the child's
body; retighten the belt strap if necessary.
RNever
secure more than one child at a
time in the child restraint system.
RThe
belt must be routed through the
hook.
RThe
belt strap must not be trapped or
twisted, nor rub against any sharp edges.
* optional
Folding in the child seat
X
Ris
tight and is routed across the middle
of the child's shoulder
Ris
not twisted and does not pass across
the child's neck or under the child's arm
X
Adjust the head restraint (Y page 66)
1 Release catch
X
X
Press release catch 1.
Push the child seat back into the seat until
it engages.
Padded table*for the integrated child
seat*
For children between approximately two and
four years of age or weighing between
approximately 12.5 kg and 22 kg, you must
also use a padded table which has been specially approved for the integrated child seat.
You can obtain the approved padded table
with ECE approval number 03301101 from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre under the
order number B6 687 0096.
51
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 52
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
You must not use the integrated child seat
with padded table directly attached to a baby
car seat on which a body weight of up to
10 kg is permitted.
G Risk of injury
If the padded table is not installed and used
correctly on the integrated child seat, it
cannot provide the intended protection. It
would then not be possible to restrain the
child in the event of an accident, sudden
braking or abrupt change in direction and
this could result in serious or even fatal
injury to the child. For this reason, observe
the following description when fitting the
padded table:
The padded table is only suitable for use
together with the folded-out integrated
child seat.
On the rear seats, only use the padded table
which is recommended for Mercedes-Benz
vehicles.
An incorrectly fitted padded table could
come loose and seriously or even fatally
injure the child or other vehicle occupants.
Fit the padded table and ensure that it is
correctly secured.
52
G Risk of injury
If the padded table is damaged or subjected
to a load in an accident, it cannot provide
the intended protection. It would then not
be possible to restrain the child in the event
of an accident, sudden braking or abrupt
change in direction and this could result in
serious or even fatal injury to the child.
You must therefore have padded tables
that are damaged or have been subjected
to a heavy load in an accident checked
immediately along with their mountings at
a qualified specialist workshop and
replaced if necessary.
G Risk of injury
To reduce the risk of serious or even fatal
injury to the child in the event of a sudden
change in direction, braking or an accident:
Robserve the following description when
fitting the padded table.
Rdo
not modify the padded table.
RWhen
the child seat is occupied, adjust
the head restraint to a position at which
the back of the child's head is supported
by the centre of the head restraint at
about eye level.
Rreplace
a damaged padded table or one
that has been subjected to a load in an
accident.
Rbe
aware that children under two years
of age or children weighing less than
12.5 kg require a different child restraint
system. Information about other child
restraint systems is available from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
Do not modify the padded table, integrated
child seat or seat belts. The padded table
must not be used without a cover. The
cover must not be removed from the padded table or replaced with a cover from
another manufacturer. Otherwise, the official approval becomes invalid and its protective function could be restricted.
Do not subject the padded table to unnecessary heat nor expose it to direct sunlight.
Parts of the padded table could heat up and
the child could be burnt by the hot parts.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 53
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
! Make sure that the padded table is not
trapped or damaged, for example when
you:
Rclose
the doors
Radjust
the seat
Rstore
the padded table or transport
heavy objects
Fitting the padded table
1 Head restraint
2 Padded table
3 Seat belt guide points
4 Hook
5 Left leg
6 Integrated child seat
7 Right leg
Fold out integrated child seat 6
(Y page 50).
X Place the child on integrated child seat
6.
X Fold both legs 5 and 7 down.
X Place padded table 2 over integrated child
seat 6.
X
G Risk of injury
Ensure that:
Rthe belt is routed as described below
Rthe belt is not twisted
Rthe padded table is close to the child's
body
Rthe belt is routed through the hook
Rthe belt strap is not trapped or twisted
and does not rub against any sharp edges
It would otherwise not be possible to
restrain the child in the event of an accident, sudden braking or abrupt change in
direction and this could result in serious or
even fatal injury to the child.
Pull the belt smoothly from the inertia reel.
Guide the lower section of the belt through
hook 4.
X Attach the lower and upper sections of the
belt in left seat belt guide point 3.
X Guide both sections of the belt to right seat
belt guide point 3 and attach.
X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt
buckle.
X Slide padded table 2 close to the child's
body.
X Pull both parts of the belt tight. Ensure that
the belt is not twisted.
X Adjust the head restraint (Y page 66)
X
X
Storing the padded table
G Risk of injury
The padded table must be secured in the
vehicle correctly or stowed securely in the
luggage compartment. It could otherwise
become loose in the event of an accident,
sudden braking or abrupt change in direction and could injure vehicle occupants or
cause damage to the vehicle.
X
Fold in both legs 5 and 7.
Z
53
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 54
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Occupant safety
Child-proof locks
If children are travelling in the vehicle, you can
activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors.
Child-proof locks on the rear doors (5door vehicles)
The child-proof locks on the rear doors enable
you to secure each door individually. A locked
door cannot be opened from the inside. The
door can be opened from the outside if the
vehicle is unlocked.
G Risk of accident and injury
Activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors and the override switch for the rear
compartment side windows when children
are travelling in the vehicle. The children
could otherwise open doors or windows
while the vehicle is in motion and injure
themselves or others.
1 To deactivate
2 To activate
To activate: press latch 2 downwards.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X
X
To deactivate: press latch 1 upwards.
1 Switch
X
To activate/deactivate: press switch 1.
Switch 1 engages or pops up. If the rear
switch is engaged, you can only operate the
rear side windows using the switches on
the driver's door.
Child-proof locks for the electric side windows in the rear*(5-door vehicle)
G Risk of accident and injury
Activate the child-proof locks for the rear
doors and the override switch for the rear
compartment side windows when children
are travelling in the vehicle. The children
could otherwise open doors or windows
while the vehicle is in motion and injure
themselves or others.
54
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 55
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
Overview of driving safety systems
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
RBAS
(Brake Assist System)
RESP®
(Electronic Stability Program)
RSteering
assistant STEER CONTROL
i In wintry road conditions, always use winter tyres (M+S tyres) and, where necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
G Risk of accident
The risk of an accident is significantly
increased by driving too fast. This is particularly the case when cornering as well as
on wet or slippery roads or when driving too
close to the vehicle in front.
The driving safety systems described in this
section can neither reduce this risk nor
override the laws of physics.
For this reason, always adapt your driving
style to suit prevailing road and weather
conditions. Maintain sufficient distance
from other road users and objects on the
road.
X
To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
G Risk of accident
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
ABS works from a speed of about 8 km/h
upwards, regardless of road surface conditions. ABS works on slippery surfaces, even
when you only brake gently.
G Risk of accident
Do not depress the brake pedal several
times in quick succession (pumping).
Depress the brake firmly and evenly. Pumping the brake pedal reduces the braking
effect.
Braking
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel
a pulsing in the brake pedal.
X
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal with force until the braking situation is over.
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. This limits the steerability of the
vehicle when braking and the braking distance may increase.
If ABS is deactivated due to a malfunction,
then BAS and ESP are also deactivated.
There is an increased risk of your vehicle
skidding in certain situations.
You should always adapt your driving style
to suit prevailing road and weather conditions.
BAS (Brake Assist)
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
X Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
Z
55
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 56
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Driving safety systems
G Risk of accident
If BAS has malfunctioned, the braking system remains available with full brake boosting effect. However, braking force is not
automatically increased in emergency
braking situations and the stopping distance may increase.
Adaptive brake lamps
i Adaptive brake lamps are only available in
certain countries.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 50 km/h or if braking is assisted by BAS,
the brake lamps flash rapidly. In this way,
traffic travelling behind you is warned in an
even more noticeable manner.
If you brake sharply from a speed of more
than 70 km/h to a standstill, the hazard warning lamps are activated automatically. If the
brakes are applied again, the brake lamps
light up continuously. The hazard warning
lamps switch off automatically if you travel
faster than 10 km/h. You can also switch off
the hazard warning lamps using the hazard
warning switch button (Y page 80).
ESP®(Electronic Stability Program)
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between tyres and
the road surface.
ESP® detects when a wheel spins or the vehicle starts to skid. ESP® stabilises the vehicle
by targeted braking of individual wheels and
by limiting engine power. It assists you when
pulling away on wet or slippery roads. ESP®
also stabilises the vehicle during braking.
When ESP® intervenes, the v warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
G Risk of accident
If the v warning lamp in the instrument
cluster flashes, proceed as follows:
Ronly depress the accelerator pedal as far
as necessary when pulling away.
Radapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
The vehicle could otherwise go into a skid.
ESP® cannot reduce the risk of an accident
if you drive too fast. ESP® cannot override
the laws of physics.
! The ignition must be switched off (key in
position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock), if:
56
Rthe parking brake is being tested using a
dynamometer
Rthe
vehicle is being towed with the front
axle raised
Application of the brakes by ESP® could
otherwise destroy the brake system on the
front axle.
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tyre sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
Steering assistant STEER CONTROL
The steering assistant STEER CONTROL helps
you by transmitting a noticeable steering
force to the steering wheel in the direction
required for vehicle stabilisation. This steering assistance is provided in particular if:
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake
Rthe
vehicle starts to skid
You have control over the steering at all
times.
G Risk of accident
If there is an ESP® malfunction, you will not
receive any steering assistance from the
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 57
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Anti-theft systems
steering assistant STEER CONTROL. The
steering continues to function with power
assistance.
Anti-theft systems
Immobiliser
The immobiliser prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct key.
X To activate: remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
To deactivate: turn the key to position 2
in the ignition lock.
1 Indicator lamp
ATA* (anti-theft alarm system)
A visual and audible alarm is triggered when
the alarm system is primed and you open:
Ra
door
Ra
door using the emergency key element
Rthe
tailgate
Rthe
bonnet
The alarm is not switched off even if you close
a door again.
To prime: lock the vehicle using the key.
Indicator lamp 1 flashes. The alarm system is primed after approximately 15 seconds.
X To deactivate: unlock the vehicle using the
key.
X
Deactivating the alarm
X
Insert the key into the ignition lock.
The alarm is deactivated.
or
X
Press the k or j button on the key.
The alarm is deactivated.
Z
* optional
57
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 58
Version: 2.10.6
Safety
Anti-theft systems
Tow-away protection* and interior
motion sensor*
When tow-away protection and the interior
motion sensor have been primed, a visual and
audible alarm is triggered, if:
Rmotion is detected in the vehicle interior,
e.g. if the side windows of the vehicle are
smashed.
Rthe inclination of your vehicle changes, e.g.
if one end of your vehicle is raised.
Priming tow-away protection and interior motion sensor
Make sure that:
Rthe side windows are closed
X
Rthe
panorama louvred sliding sunroof* is
closed.
Rthere are no objects, e.g. mascots, hanging
on the rear-view mirror or on the grab handles on the roof trim.
This will prevent false alarms.
X
Deactivating tow-away protection and
interior motion sensor
To prevent a false alarm, deactivate the towaway protection and the interior motion sensor if your vehicle:
Ris
being transported or towed
Ris
being loaded, e.g. onto a ferry or car
transporter
Ris
parked on a movable surface, e.g. splitlevel garages
Ris
locked while persons or animals remain
inside
Ris
locked while the side windows remain
open
Ris locked and the panorama louvred sliding
sunroof* remains open
1 To deactivate tow-away protection/inte-
rior motion sensor
2 Indicator lamp
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 lights up briefly.
X Lock the vehicle using the key.
Tow-away protection and the interior
motion sensor remain deactivated until the
vehicle is unlocked and locked again.
X
X
Lock the vehicle using the key.
Tow-away protection and the interior
motion sensor are primed after approximately 30 seconds.
58
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 59
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Opening and closing ...........................
Key positions .......................................
Seats ....................................................
Steering wheel ....................................
Mirrors .................................................
Seat belts .............................................
Lights ...................................................
Windscreen wipers .............................
Side windows ......................................
60
62
63
70
70
73
77
83
84
Driving and parking ............................ 87
Transmission ....................................... 92
Instrument cluster .............................. 97
On-board computer ............................. 98
Driving systems ................................ 115
Air conditioning ................................. 129
Roof .................................................... 142
Loading and stowing ........................ 144
Features ............................................. 162
59
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 60
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Opening and closing
Opening and closing
X
Key
The key centrally locks/unlocks:
To change the setting: press the k
and j buttons simultaneously for
approximately six seconds until the battery
check lamp flashes twice.
Rthe
doors
The key now functions as follows:
Rthe
tailgate
X
Rthe
fuel filler flap
G Risk of accident
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle, they could:
Ropen a door from the inside at any time,
even if it has been locked
Rstart
the vehicle using a key which has
been left in the vehicle
Rrelease
the parking brake
They could endanger themselves and others. Never leave children unsupervised in
the vehicle. Always take the key with you
when leaving the vehicle, even if you are
only leaving it for a short time.
1 Battery check lamp
2 j To lock the vehicle
3 Emergency key element release catch
4 k To unlock the vehicle
When unlocking, the turn signals flash once.
When locking, they flash three times.
If you do not open either a door or the tailgate
after you have unlocked the vehicle, it will
automatically relock after approximately 40
seconds.
Individual settings
You can change the setting of the locking
system in such a way that only the driver's
door and the fuel filler flap are unlocked. This
could be useful if you frequently travel on your
own.
60
To unlock the driver's door: press the
k button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the k button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the j button.
Restoring the factory settings
X
Press the k and j buttons simultaneously for approximately six seconds until
the battery check lamp flashes twice.
Additional information
RConvenience
closing (Y page 86)
RConvenience
opening (Y page 86)
ROpening
and closing in an emergency
(Y page 241)
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 61
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Opening and closing
Opening the doors from the inside
You can open a door from the inside at any
time, even if it has been locked.
Automatic locking feature
The vehicle will lock automatically once you
have pulled away.
You can switch off the automatic locking
function via the on-board computer
(Y page 111).
i The vehicle is locked automatically when
the ignition is switched on and the wheels
begin to turn. There is therefore a risk of
being locked out when the vehicle is being
pushed or tested on a dynamometer.
X
X
X
Pull door handle 2.
If the door is locked, locking knob 1 pops
up. The door is unlocked and can be
opened.
Locking/unlocking the vehicle from
the inside
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. This feature may be useful if,
for example, you wish to unlock the
passenger door from the inside or lock the
vehicle before you pull away.
G Risk of accident
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle. They could open a door from the
inside – even if it is locked – and thereby
endanger themselves and others.
To lock: press button 1.
To unlock: press button 2.
Tailgate
G Risk of poisoning
Exhaust fumes could enter the vehicle interior if the engine is running and the tailgate
is open. This could poison you. You should
therefore make sure that the tailgate is
always closed when the engine is running.
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
Z
61
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 62
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Key positions
Opening from the outside
Key positions
You can only open the tailgate after unlocking
it first.
X To unlock centrally: press the k button on the key.
Pull the tailgate down using recess 1.
Push the tailgate closed from the outside.
X Lock the vehicle if necessary with
the ‹ button on the key.
X
X
Pull handle 1.
X Raise the tailgate.
X
Closing from the outside
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped as you close the tailgate.
i Do not leave the key in the luggage compartment. You could otherwise lock yourself out.
62
} To remove the key
$ Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windscreen wipers
% Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
& To start the engine
i Even if the key is not for the vehicle in
question, it will still turn in the ignition lock.
The ignition is not switched on. The engine
cannot be started.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 63
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Seats
Points to remember
You can find information about enlarging the
luggage compartment (folding forwards/
removing the rear seats) on (Y page 150).
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the
seats can be adjusted either manually or electrically.
G Risk of injury
The seats can be adjusted when the key is
removed and the door is open. For this reason, children should never be left unsupervised in the vehicle. They could become
trapped when adjusting a seat.
G Risk of accident
Only adjust the driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary. You will otherwise be distracted from the road and traffic conditions
and you could lose control of the vehicle as
a result of the seat moving. This could
cause an accident.
G Risk of injury
Observe the notes concerning the airbag
system.
Secure children as recommended; see
"Children in the vehicle" section.
Adjusting the seat manually
! When you move the seats, make sure that
there are no objects in the footwell or
behind the seats. Otherwise, you could
damage the seats and the objects.
i The front seats are fitted with active head
restraints (Y page 42). For this reason, it is
not possible to remove the head restraints
from the front seats.
The rear-compartment head restraints can
be removed (Y page 66).
Please contact a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for more information.
1 Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
2 Seat cushion angle*
3 Seat height
4 Backrest angle
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Lift handle 1 and slide the seat forwards
or backwards.
X Release handle 1 again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage
into position.
X
Make sure that nobody can become trapped when you adjust the seat.
Z
* optional
63
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 64
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Backrest angle
X
X
Head restraint angle
Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
Turn handwheel 4 forwards or backwards.
Seat height
X
Pull up or push down handle 3 repeatedly
until the seat has reached the desired
height.
Seat cushion angle*
1 Release catch
Adjust the angle so that your thighs are lightly
supported.
X Turn handwheel 2 forwards or backwards.
X
Head restraint height
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch 1 in direction of arrow and push the head restraint
down to the desired position.
X
Push or pull the upper edge of the head
restraint in direction of arrow.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the central area of the head
restraint supports the back of your head at
about eye level. You could seriously injure
your neck if your head is not correctly supported by the head restraint in the event of
an accident. Never travel without a correctly adjusted and engaged head restraint.
64
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 65
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Adjusting the seat electrically*
Seat height
X
Slide the button up or down in the direction
of arrow 5.
X
Slide the button up or down in the direction
of arrow 1.
Head restraint angle
Seat cushion angle
Adjust the angle so that your thighs are gently
supported.
X Slide the button up or down in the direction
of arrow 4.
1 Head restraint height
2 Backrest angle
3 Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
4 Seat cushion angle
5 Seat height
X
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock or that the respective
door is open.
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
X
Slide the button forwards or back in the
direction of arrow 3.
Backrest angle
X
Slide the button forwards or back in the
direction of arrow 2.
Head restraint height
X
Push or pull the upper edge of the head
restraint in the direction of the arrow.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the central area of the head
restraint supports the back of your head at
about eye level. You could seriously injure
your neck if your head is not correctly supported by the head restraint in the event of
an accident. Never travel without a correctly adjusted and engaged head restraint.
Z
* optional
65
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 66
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the head restraint height
X
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired height.
X
To lower: press release catch 1 and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the central area of the head
restraint supports the back of your head at
about eye level. You could seriously injure
your neck if your head is not correctly supported by the head restraint in the event of
an accident. Never travel without a correctly adjusted and engaged head restraint.
Adjusting the angle of the outer head
restraints
X
1 Release catch
66
Pull the bottom of the head restraint forwards or push it backwards.
Fitting and removing the rear-compartment head restraints
G Risk of injury
Occupants should only travel sitting on
seats which have the head restraints installed. This reduces the risk of injury to the
passengers in the rear in the event of an
accident.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 67
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Armrest* between the front seats
You can slide the armrest forwards or backwards.
Folding the front seat backrests forwards/EASY-ENTRY feature (3-door
vehicle)
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of entrapment when you
move the armrest.
i There is a small stowage compartment
underneath the armrest at the rear. This
becomes accessible after you have moved
the armrest forwards.
1 Release catch
Fold the rear seat backrest forwards
slightly in order to remove the head
restraint.
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch 1 and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To refit: insert the head restraint so that
the notches on the bar are on the left when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it click into place.
X
1 Seat release
i For easier access to the rear, you can
slide the seat further forwards once you
have folded the backrest forwards, as long
as the seat is in the rear half of the adjustment range.
1 Armrest
Moving the armrest
X
* optional
Slide armrest 1 into the desired position.
Z
67
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 68
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Folding the backrest forwards
Lumbar support*
Push the backrest backwards slightly, pull
seat release 1 forwards and fold the backrest forwards until it engages.
X Slide the seat forwards whilst pulling the
seat release.
X Swing the belt guide downwards.
X
The lumbar support for the front seats can be
adjusted to provide optimum support for your
back.
Folding back the backrest
Pull the seat release and slide the seat
backwards until it engages.
X Fold down the backrest until the seat and
backrest engage.
X Swing the belt guide up.
X
1 Armrest
! Do not sit or lean on the armrest when it
is folded down as you could otherwise damage it.
X
Armrest* (rear seat backrest)
i There is a cup holder in the armrest
(Y page 144). The armrest can be removed
(Y page 147).
68
To fold the armrest down/up: swing armrest 1 all the way down or all the way up.
! Only fold the armrest up once you have
1 Adjustment lever
X
Move adjustment lever 1 until the desired
backrest contour is achieved.
closed the cup holder.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 69
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seats
Multi-contour backrest*
You can adjust the contour of the front seats
individually so as to provide optimum support
for your back.
Upper back support
X
The system automatically switches down
from level 2 to level 1 after approximately
ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Use button 2 to adjust the upper back
support to the desired position.
Backrest side cushions
X
Use button 3 to adjust the backrest side
cushions to the desired position.
Seat heating*
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press button 1 repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button 1 repeatedly
until all indicator lamps go out.
X
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
1 Lumbar region support
2 Upper back support
3 Backrest side cushions
X
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
Lumbar region support
X
Use button 1 to adjust the lumbar region
support to the desired position.
1 Seat heating
i The system automatically switches down
from level 3 to level 2 after approximately
five minutes.
* optional
Z
69
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 70
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Mirrors
Steering wheel
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
G Risk of accident
Only adjust the steering wheel when the
vehicle is stationary and do not pull away
until the steering wheel adjustment mechanism is locked in position. You might otherwise drive without the steering wheel
adjustment mechanism being locked in
position. As a result you could be distracted
from road and traffic conditions by an unexpected movement of the steering wheel
and thereby cause an accident.
However, the steerability of the vehicle is
not affected.
When you adjust the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Rthe steering wheel can be reached with
your arms slightly bent
Ryou
Ryou
can move your legs freely
can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly
X
Adjust the rear-view mirror by hand so you
have a good overview of the traffic conditions.
Rear-view mirror (manual anti-dazzle)
1 Release lever
2 Height adjustment
3 Fore-and-aft adjustment
Pull handle 1 out completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push handle 1 in completely until you hear
it engage.
The steering wheel is locked in position.
X
1 Anti-dazzle switch
X
Anti-dazzle mode: flick anti-dazzle switch
1 forwards or back.
Rear-view mirror (automatic anti-dazzle*)
The rear-view mirror automatically goes into
anti-dazzle mode if the ignition is switched on
70
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 71
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Mirrors
and incident light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror.
The mirrors do not go into anti-dazzle mode if
reverse gear is engaged and the interior lighting is switched on.
G Risk of accident
If the incident light from headlamps cannot
strike the sensor in the rear-view mirror, for
instance by objects in the vehicle, the mirrors' automatic anti-dazzle function will not
operate.
Incident light could then dazzle you. This
may prevent you from observing the traffic
conditions, thereby causing an accident. In
this case, adjust the rear-view mirror manually.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G Risk of accident
The exterior mirrors reduce the size of the
image. Objects are actually closer than
they appear. You could misjudge the distance from vehicles driving behind and
cause an accident, e.g. when changing
lane. For this reason, make sure of the
actual distance from the vehicle driving
behind by glancing over your shoulder.
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
At low outside temperatures, the exterior mirrors are heated automatically.
1 Adjustment button
2 Right-hand exterior mirror
3 Left-hand exterior mirror
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press button 2 for the right-hand exterior
mirror or button 3 for the left-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button 1 as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button 1 up, down, to
the right or to the left until the exterior mirX
71
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 72
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Mirrors
ror is set to a position which provides you
with a good overview of traffic conditions.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
electrically*
Resetting the exterior mirrors
If the battery has been disconnected or has
become discharged, the exterior mirrors
must be reset. If this is not done, the exterior
mirrors will not fold in when you select the
"Fold in mirrors when locking" function in the
on-board computer (Y page 111).
X Make sure that the key is in position 1 in
the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button 1.
can only fold out the exterior mirrors again
using button 1.
Folding the exterior mirrors in or out
automatically*
1 To fold the exterior mirrors in or out
Make sure that the key is in position 1 or
2 in the ignition lock.
X Briefly press button 1.
Both exterior mirrors fold in or out.
X
i Make sure that the exterior mirrors are
always folded out fully while the vehicle is
in motion; otherwise, they may vibrate.
If the "Fold in mirrors when locking" function
is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 111):
Rthe exterior mirrors fold in automatically as
soon as you lock the vehicle from the outside.
RThe
exterior mirrors fold out again automatically as soon as you unlock the vehicle
and then open the driver's or frontpassenger door.
i If you have activated this function and fold
in the exterior mirrors using button 1, they
will not be folded out automatically. You
72
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 73
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seat belts
Seat belts
Wearing seat belts
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restraining the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. This
reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming
into contact with the vehicle interior.
G Risk of injury
A seat belt which is not worn correctly, or
which has not been engaged in the seat belt
buckle correctly, cannot perform its intended protective function. Under certain circumstances this could cause severe or
even fatal injuries.
Make sure that all occupants – in particular,
pregnant women – wear their seat belt correctly at all times.
RThe seat belt must pass closely over your
body and must not be twisted. You
should therefore avoid wearing bulky
clothing (e.g. a winter coat). The shoulder
belt section must be routed across the
middle of your shoulder – on no account
across your neck or under your arm – and
pulled tight against your upper body. The
lap belt must always pass across your lap
as low down as possible, i.e. over your
hip joints – not across your abdomen. If
necessary, push down the belt strap
slightly and then retighten it in the roll-up
direction.
R3-door
vehicle: the swivelling belt guide
must be in the correct position.
RDo
not route the belt strap across sharp
or fragile objects, especially if these are
located on or in your clothing, e.g. spectacles, pencils, keys, etc. The seat belt
strap could be damaged and tear in an
accident and you or other vehicle occupants could be injured.
ROnly
one person should use each seat
belt at any one time. Children must never
travel sitting on the lap of other occupants. It would not be possible to restrain
the child in the event of a sudden change
in direction, braking or an accident. This
could result in severe or even fatal injuries to the child and other occupants.
RPersons
less than 1.50 m tall cannot
wear the seat belts correctly. For this
reason, secure persons less than 1.50 m
tall in specially designed, suitable
restraint systems.
RChildren
less than 1.50 m tall or under
12 years of age cannot wear the seat
belts properly. Therefore, always secure
these children in suitable child restraint
systems on suitable vehicle seats. You
can find more information under "Children in the vehicle" in the "Safety" section of the Owner's Manual. Follow the
manufacturer's installation instructions
when fitting the child restraint system.
RDo not secure any objects with a seat belt
if the seat belt is also being used by one
of the vehicle's occupants.
G Risk of injury
The seat belt does not offer the intended
level of protection unless the backrest is
almost vertical. Under certain circumstances this could cause severe or even fatal
injuries.
Before starting a journey, make sure that
the seat is properly adjusted and that the
backrest is almost vertical.
G Risk of injury
A dirty or damaged seat belt or a seat belt
that has been subjected to a load in an
accident or modified no longer offers the
73
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 74
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seat belts
intended level of protection. Under certain
circumstances this could cause severe or
even fatal injuries.
For this reason, check regularly that the
seat belts are not damaged or dirty.
Always have damaged seat belts or seat
belts that have been subjected to a load in
an accident replaced at a qualified specialist workshop. Choose a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools for the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat belts which
have been approved by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle.
3-door vehicle
1 Belt sash guide
5-door vehicle
1 Belt sash guide
2 Belt tongue
3 Buckle
2 Belt tongue
3 Buckle
4 Release button
5 Swivelling belt guide
4 Release button
Routing the belt
Adjust the seat and move the backrest to
an almost vertical position (Y page 63).
X Pull the belt smoothly through belt sash
guide 1.
X
74
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 75
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seat belts
Route the belt over the centre of the shoulder without twisting it.
X Engage belt tongue 2 into buckle 3.
X 5-door vehicle: if necessary, adjust the
belt to the appropriate height
(Y page 75).
X 3-door vehicles: make sure that swivelling
belt guide 5 is in the correct position.
X All: if necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder section of the belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
Routing the belt
X
Press release button 4 and guide belt
tongue 2 back towards belt sash guide
1.
Belt warning for driver and front
passenger
The < seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster reminds you that all passengers
should fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. Additionally, there may
be a warning tone.
The < seat belt warning lamp goes out and
the acoustic signal ceases as soon as the
driver and passenger have fastened their seat
belts.
For certain countries only: regardless of
whether the driver or the front passenger
already have their seat belt fastened, the
< seat belt warning lamp lights up for six
seconds after the engine has been started. It
then goes out when the driver and front
passenger have already fastened their seat
belts.
i Further information about the < seat
belt warning lamp (Y page 228).
Belt height adjustment
5-door vehicles only: you can adjust the
seat belt height on the driver's seat and frontpassenger seat.
Adjust the belt to a height that allows it to be
routed across the middle of your shoulder.
1 Release catch
To raise: slide the belt sash guide upwards.
The belt sash guide engages in various positions.
X To lower: press and hold release button
1.
X Slide the belt sash guide downwards.
X Let go of release button 1 and make sure
that the belt sash guide has engaged.
X
Z
75
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 76
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Seat belts
Rear seat belt status indicator
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator tells you if the rear passengers have
fastened their seat belts. The status indicator
for the rear rear-compartment also tells you
how many of the belt tongues are inserted
into the seat belt buckles.
The rear-compartment seat belt status indicator appears in the multi-function display for
around 30 seconds if:
i The status indicator for the rear-compartment seat belts is only available for certain
countries.
Correct driver's seat position
Only adjust the steering wheel when the
vehicle is stationary and do not pull away
until the steering wheel adjustment mechanism is locked in position. You might otherwise drive without the steering wheel
adjustment mechanism being locked in
position. As a result, you could be distracted from road and traffic conditions by an
unexpected movement of the steering
wheel and thereby cause an accident.
However, the steerability of the vehicle is
not affected.
set off and have reached a speed of
approx. 10 km/h
Rthe
rear passengers fasten or unfasten
their seat belts while driving
gets in or out of the vehicle
You can also cancel the messages immediately (Y page 202).
The following messages appear in the multifunction display:
R< No rear seat belt engaged
R<
1 rear seat belt engaged
R<
2 rear seat belts engaged
R<
3 rear seat belts engaged
76
Only adjust the driver's seat when the vehicle is stationary. You will otherwise be distracted from the road and traffic conditions
and you could lose control of the vehicle as
a result of the seat moving. This could
cause an accident.
G Risk of accident
Ryou
Rsomeone
G Risk of accident
X
1 Steering wheel
2 Seat belt
3 Seat
Check whether seat 3 and the head
restraint are adjusted properly
(Y page 63).
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 77
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
Make sure that:
It should:
Ryou are as far away from the driver's front
Rfit
airbag as possible
Ryou
are sitting in a normal upright posi-
Ryou
can fasten the seat belt properly
tion
Ryou
have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position
Ryou
have set the seat angle so that your
thighs are gently supported
Ryou
can depress the pedals properly
Ryou
have adjusted the head restraint so
that the back of your head is supported
at eye level by the central area of the
head restraint
X
Check whether steering wheel 1 is adjusted properly (Y page 70).
Make sure that:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
Lights
snugly across your body
Rbe
routed across the middle of your
shoulder
Rrouted
joints
in your pelvic area across the hip
Light switch
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, daytime operation of headlamps varies
due to legal and voluntary requirements. In
these countries, the constant headlamp
mode is automatically switched on when the
engine is started.
i If you drive in countries in which traffic
drives on the opposite side of the road to
the country where the vehicle is registered,
oncoming traffic may be dazzled by the
asymmetrical dipped-beam headlamps.
Have the headlamps changed to symmetrical dipped beam when driving in these
countries. You can obtain information
about this from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
arms slightly bent
Ryou
can move your legs freely
Ryou can see all the displays in the instru-
ment cluster clearly
X
Check whether you have fastened seat belt
2 properly (Y page 73).
Z
77
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 78
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
while the ignition is switched off (ignition
key in position 0).
i When you turn the light switch to any
position other than M or U, the corresponding light goes on.
! Switch off the side lamps and parking
lamp when you leave the vehicle. This prevents the battery from discharging.
Dipped-beam headlamps
Turn the ignition key to position 2 in the
ignition lock or start the engine.
X To switch on: turn the light switch to
B.
X
$ a Left-hand parking lamp
% g Right-hand parking lamp8
& M Lights off/constant headlamp mode
( U Automatic headlamp mode/con)C
*B
,¥
.†
stant headlamp mode
Side lamps, licence plate and instrument lighting
Dipped-beam headlamps or mainbeam headlamps
foglamps*
Rear foglamp
i The exterior lighting (except for side
lamps and parking lamps) automatically
switches off when you remove the key from
the ignition lock or open the driver's door
8
Constant headlamp mode
In countries in which constant headlamp
mode is not a legal requirement, you can
make this a setting using the on-board computer.
You can activate or deactivate "constant
headlamp mode" using the on-board computer (Y page 109).
X To switch on: turn the light switch to
M or U.
The dipped-beam headlamps are switched
on when the engine is running.
Automatic headlamp mode
G Risk of accident
When the light switch is set to U, the
lights are not switched on automatically in
foggy conditions. This could endanger you
and others. Therefore, turn the light switch
to B in darkness and fog.
Automatic headlamp mode is only a driving
aid. You are responsible for the vehicle
lighting at all times.
G Risk of accident
When it is dark or foggy, turn the light
switch from U to B in good time.
Otherwise, the headlamps could switch off
temporarily and you could cause an accident.
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to
U.
Key in position 1 in the ignition lock: the
side lamp is switched on or off automatically, depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
You must turn the light switch beyond its resistance point when turning it from the M position to the g position.
78
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 79
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
Starting the engine: the dipped-beam headlamps are also switched on or off automatically, depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
When the dipped-beam headlamps are
switched on, the B indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
Front foglamps*/Rear foglamp
G Risk of accident
If you suspect that driving conditions will be
foggy, turn the light switch to B before
you start your journey. Otherwise, your
vehicle may not be visible and you could
endanger yourself and others.
When the light switch is set to U you cannot switch on the front* or rear foglamps.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To switch on the front foglamps*: turn
the light switch to the B or C position.
X Pull the light switch out to the first detent.
The ¥ green indicator lamp next to the
light switch lights up.
X
To switch on the rear foglamp: turn the
light switch to B or C.
X
On vehicles with front foglamps*, pull the
light switch out to the second detent.
On vehicles without front foglamps*, pull
the light switch out to the detent.
The † yellow indicator lamp next to the
light switch lights up.
X
To switch off the front foglamps*/rear
foglamp: push in the light switch to the
stop.
The corresponding indicator lamp goes out.
Combination switch (turn signals,
main-beam headlamps and headlamp
flasher)
Turn signal lamp
X
To switch on: press the combination
switch in the direction of arrow 2 or ?.
The corresponding turn signal indicator
lamp K or L in the instrument cluster flashes.
i If you only wish to indicate a minor change
of direction, press the combination switch
briefly in the appropriate direction. The corresponding turn signal flashes three times.
Z
* optional
79
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 80
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
Main-beam headlamps
Turn the ignition key to position 2 in the
ignition lock or start the engine.
X Turn the light switch to B or U9.
X To switch on: press the combination
switch in the direction of arrow 1.
The A main-beam indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off: move the combination
switch back to its normal position.
The A main-beam indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
Hazard warning lamps
X
Headlamp flasher
X
To switch on: briefly pull the combination
switch in the direction of arrow =.
The headlamp range control allows you to
adjust the cone of light from the headlamps
to suit the vehicle load.
You can only adjust the headlamp range while
the engine is running.
The hazard warning lamps still operate if the
ignition is switched off. They switch on automatically if an airbag is deployed or if you
brake sharply and bring the vehicle to a halt
from a speed of more than 70 km/h.
X To switch on: press button 1.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on
a turn signal using the combination switch
(Y page 79), only the turn signal lamp on
the corresponding side of the vehicle will
flash.
X
9
To switch off: press button 1.
In the U position, the main-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark.
80
Adjusting the headlamp range (halogen headlamps)
Position
Load
0
Driver's seat and frontpassenger seat occupied
1
Driver's seat, frontpassenger seat and rear
seats occupied
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 81
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
Position
Load
2
Driver's seat, front passenger
seat and rear seats occupied,
luggage compartment laden
3
X
Not required
Turn headlamp range control 1 to the
position which corresponds to the load in
your vehicle.
Headlamp cleaning system*
The headlamps are cleaned automatically if
the "Wipe with windscreen washer fluid" function is operated five times while the lights are
on and the engine is running. When you
switch off the ignition, the automatic headlamp cleaning system is reset and counting is
resumed from 0.
* optional
When in reverse gear: the cornering lamp
on the outside of the bend comes on.
Cornering light function* (bi-xenon
headlamps*)
Specially designed headlamps light up the
area into which you are driving when turning
corners.
If you are driving at speeds below 40 km/h,
the cornering light function is activated either
by the turn signals or when the steering wheel
is turned. If you are driving at speeds above
40 km/h the cornering light function is deactivated.
Activating
Start the engine.
Switch on the dipped-beam headlamps.
X Switch off the foglamps*.
X Switch on the turn signal.
The cornering lamp on the same side as the
turn signal comes on, even if you turn the
steering wheel in the opposite direction
after indicating.
or
X Turn the steering wheel in the desired
direction.
When in a forwards gear: the cornering
lamp on the inside of the bend comes on.
X
Deactivating
X
Turn the steering wheel back to the straight
ahead position.
The turn signal goes off. The cornering lamp
may remain lit for a short time.
or
Switch off the turn signal.
The cornering lamp may remain lit for a
short time.
The cornering light will go out after a maximum of three minutes.
X
X
Z
81
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 82
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Lights
Interior lighting
Front overhead control panel (vehicles with a
rocker switch)
1 ð To switch the interior lighting on
2 To switch the automatic interior lighting
control on
3 ¥ To switch the interior lighting/automatic interior lighting control off
4 X To switch the reading lamp on/off
Front overhead control panel (vehicles with buttons*)
1 £ To switch the rear interior lighting
Rear-compartment overhead control panel
1 To switch the reading lamp* off
2
Automatic interior lighting control
3
4
5
on/off
¥ To switch the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
X To switch the right-hand reading
lamp on/off
X To switch the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
ð To switch the front interior lighting
on/off
2 To switch the reading lamp* on
To switch on (vehicles with a rocker
switch): set the rocker switch to centre
position 2.
X To switch on (vehicles with buttons*):
press the ¥ button.
X To switch off (vehicles with a rocker
switch): set the rocker switch to
the ¥ position.
X
To switch off (vehicles with buttons*):
press the ¥ button.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on when it is dark, when you unlock the vehiX
82
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 83
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Windscreen wipers
cle, open a door or remove the key from the
ignition lock.
The interior lighting switches off after a delay.
You can set the delayed switch-off using the
on-board computer (Y page 110). If the door
is left open, the interior lighting goes out after
approximately five minutes.
Switching the windscreen wipers on/
off
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
X
Emergency accident lighting
If the interior lighting is set to automatic, the
interior lighting is activated automatically if
the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To deactivate: press the hazard warning
lamp button (Y page 80).
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
key.
If the windscreen becomes dirty in dry
weather conditions, the windscreen wipers
may be activated inadvertently. This could
then damage the windscreen wiper blades
or scratch the windscreen.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windscreen wipers in dry weather.
Windscreen wipers
Rear window wiper
Combination switch
1 To switch on the windscreen wipers
2 Single wipe/to wipe the windscreen using
washer fluid
Settings:
0
Windscreen wipers off
I
Intermittent wipe
II
Continuous wipe, slow
III
Continuous wipe, fast
! Vehicles with a rain sensor*:
* optional
Combination switch
1 Switch
% To wipe with washer fluid
Z
83
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 84
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Side windows
& To switch on intermittent wiping
( To switch off intermittent wiping
) To wipe with washer fluid
Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
When the rear window wiper is switched on
the icon appears in the instrument cluster.
X
Side windows
Opening/closing the side windows
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped between the side window and the door
frame when a side window is opened. Do
not touch or lean against the side window
during the opening procedure. You could
become trapped between the side window
and the door frame as the side window
moves down. If there is a risk of becoming
trapped, release the switch or pull the
switch upwards to close the side window
again.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the side windows. If there
is a risk of becoming trapped, release the
switch or push the switch again to reopen
the side window.
G Risk of injury
Children may injure themselves if they
operate the side windows.
Never leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle. Always take the key with you when
84
leaving the vehicle, even if you are only
leaving it for a short time.
G Risk of injury
Do not leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle, even if they are secured in a child
restraint system. The children could:
Rbe seriously or even fatally injured on
parts of the vehicle
Rbe
seriously or even fatally injured by
prolonged exposure to extremely high or
extremely low temperatures
If children open a door, they could:
Rseriously or even fatally injure other people
Rget
out of the vehicle, thereby injuring
themselves or be seriously or even fatally
injured by a passing vehicle
Activate the child-proof locks if children are
travelling in the vehicle. They could otherwise open doors or windows while the vehicle is in motion and thereby injure themselves or others.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 85
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Side windows
i Related topics:
Rconvenience
opening (Y page 86)
Rconvenience
closing (Y page 86)
X
i You can still operate the side windows
when the key is in the 0 position or when
the key has been removed. However, this
is only possible for a maximum of five
minutes afterwards, or until the driver's or
front-passenger door is opened.
Roverride
controls in the rear compartment (Y page 54)
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
To open: press the corresponding switch.
X To close: pull the corresponding switch.
X
i If you operate the switch beyond its pres-
sure point, it will trigger automatic operation in the corresponding direction. You can
stop automatic operation by pressing
again.
Closing with increased force and without the anti-entrapment feature
1 Front left
2 Front right
3 Rear right
4 Rear left
G Risk of injury
Closing the side windows with increased
force or without the anti-entrapment feature could lead to serious or even fatal
injury. Make sure that nobody can become
trapped when closing the side windows.
If a side window blocks during closing and
reopens slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
on the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased
force.
If a side window blocks again during closing
and reopens slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull
on the corresponding switch again until the
side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the antientrapment feature.
Resetting the side windows
You must reset each side window if:
Rthe battery has been disconnected or has
become discharged.
Rthe
side window no longer opens or closes
fully.
Rthe
side windows open again slightly after
being closed fully.
Z
85
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 86
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Side windows
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch until the side
window is closed.
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X
Convenience closing*
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
If the side window opens again slightly:
X
You can ventilate the vehicle before a journey.
To do this, you can use the key to simultaneously:
Ropen
the side windows
Ropen
the panorama louvred sliding sunroof* or move it to the ventilation position
i The "Convenience opening" feature can
only be operated using the key.
86
the side windows
Rclose
the panorama louvred sliding sun-
roof*
Pull the corresponding switch again immediately and hold it for approx. one second.
Convenience opening*
Rclose
G Risk of injury
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Unlock the vehicle by pressing the k
button.
X Keep the k button pressed until the
side windows are in the desired position.
The panorama louvred sliding sunroof*
stops in the ventilation position.
X To open the panorama louvred sliding
sunroof*: press and hold the k button
again until the panorama louvred sliding
sunroof has reached the desired position.
X
When using the convenience closing feature, make sure that nobody can become
trapped. Proceed as follows if there is a risk
of entrapment:
Rrelease the j button.
Rpress
and hold the k button until the
side windows and the panorama louvred
sliding sunroof* open again.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 87
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving and parking
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door
handle.
X Lock the vehicle with the j button.
X Press and hold the j button until the
side windows and the panorama louvred
sliding sunroof* are fully closed.
X Make sure that all the side windows and the
panorama louvred sliding sunroof* are
closed.
X
Driving and parking
Starting the engine
G Risk of accident
Do not keep any objects in the driver's footwell. If you use a floormat or carpet in the
driver's footwell, make sure that they are
correctly secured and that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals.
Objects could otherwise get between the
pedals in the event of sudden braking or
acceleration. You may then no longer be
able to brake, change gear or accelerate as
intended. This may result in an accident and
injury.
G Risk of poisoning
Never leave the engine running in enclosed
spaces. The exhaust gases contain carbon
monoxide. Inhaling exhaust fumes constitutes a health hazard and could lead to loss
of consciousness or even death.
i If you depress the brake when starting the
engine, pedal travel will be unusually long
and there will be less pedal resistance.
Manual transmission
Vehicles without ECO Start-Stop-Function* (5speed manual transmission)
! Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
Z
* optional
87
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 88
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving and parking
Further information about the manual transmission (Y page 92).
Starting the engine
i Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*:
You can also use the touch-start function.
To do this, turn the key to position 3 and
release it immediately. The engine then
starts automatically.
AUTOTRONIC*
To start a petrol engine: turn the key to
position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 62)
and release it as soon as the engine is running.
X To start a diesel engine: turn the key to
position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 62).
The q preglow indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X When the q preglow indicator lamp
goes out, turn the key to position 3 and
release it as soon as the engine is running.
X
Vehicles with ECO Start-Stop-Function*
Park position with selector lever lock
To select reverse gear
To select neutral
Drive position
X Before starting, make sure P is selected.
P
R
N
D
i The engine can also be started when the
Vehicles without ECO Start Stop function* (6speed manual transmission)
Depress the brake pedal.
Depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
X Start the engine.
X
selector lever is in position N.
i You can start the engine without preglow
if the engine is warm.
X
Release the parking brake (Y page 90).
Further information about AUTOTRONIC
(Y page 94).
X
88
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 89
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving and parking
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function)
The ECO start/stop function automatically
switches on the engine as soon as you prepare to pull away, e.g. by engaging a gear.
X Depress the clutch pedal.
The engine starts automatically.
X Shift to either first or reverse gear and pull
away.
Pulling away
the engine's full performance until it has
reached operating temperature.
Only shift into reverse gear when the vehicle is stationary.
Where possible, avoid spinning the drive
wheels when pulling away on slippery
roads. You could otherwise damage the
drive train.
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
You can also deactivate the automatic locking feature (Y page 111).
i When manoeuvring in and out of parking
spaces, the ECO start/stop function will
not automatically switch off the vehicle's
engine. The engine will only be switched off
automatically if the vehicle has reached a
speed of at least 15 km/h before coming
to a standstill again.
i The system can differentiate between
starting the engine with the key and the
automatic engine start via the ECO start/
stop function.
* optional
ning the wheels. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
! Warm up the engine quickly. Do not use
! Do not engage a gear without depressing
the clutch as this disables the automatic
engine start function. As a result, the battery cannot be recharged and the demister
function of Thermotronic* is not available.
! Change gear in good time and avoid spin-
AUTOTRONIC*
i It is only possible to move the selector
lever to the desired position if you depress
the brake pedal. Only then is the selector
lever lock released.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
The selector lever lock is released.
X Release the parking brake.
X Move the selector lever to position D or R.
X
i Wait until the shift process is completed
before pulling away.
X
Release the brake pedal.
Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
Manual transmission
X
Depress the brake pedal.
X Depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to either first or reverse gear.
X Release the parking brake (Y page 90).
X Slowly release the clutch pedal and
depress the accelerator pedal.
i Upshifts take place at higher engine
X
speeds after a cold start. This helps the
catalytic converter to reach its operating
temperature more quickly.
Z
89
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 90
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving and parking
Hill start assist
Hill start assist helps you when pulling away
on uphill gradients. It holds the vehicle for a
short time after you have removed your foot
from the brake pedal. This gives you enough
time to move your foot from the brake pedal
to the accelerator pedal and depress it before
the vehicle begins to roll.
G Risk of accident
Never leave the vehicle when it is held by
hill start assist. After approximately one
second, hill start assist will no longer brake
your vehicle and it could roll away.
X
Remove your foot from the brake pedal.
i Once you have taken your foot off the
brake pedal, the vehicle is held for around
one second.
Pull away.
Hill start assist does not function if:
X
Rthe
vehicle is secured with the parking
brake.
RESP®
Parking brake
is malfunctioning.
Parking
G Risk of accident
Only remove the key from the ignition lock
when the vehicle is stationary as you cannot steer the vehicle with the key removed.
Never leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle. They could release the parking
brake. This could lead to a serious or fatal
accident.
G Risk of fire
Make sure that the exhaust system does
not under any circumstances come into
contact with easily ignitable material such
as dry grass or petrol. The material could
otherwise ignite and set the vehicle on fire.
1 Parking brake
2 Release button
X
To apply: pull parking brake 1 up firmly.
The 3 warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up if the engine is running.
i On steep slopes, turn the front wheels
towards the kerb.
Ryou
are pulling away on a level road or a
downhill gradient.
Ron
vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*, the selector lever is in the N position.
90
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 91
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving and parking
To release: depress the brake pedal and
keep it depressed.
On vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*, the selector lever lock is released.
X Press release button 2 on parking brake
1 and move the parking brake down to the
stop.
The 3 warning lamp in the instrument
cluster goes out.
X
Switching off the engine
G Risk of accident
If the engine is not running, there is no
power assistance for the steering and
brakes. Steering and braking then takes
much more effort.
As a result, you might lose control of the
vehicle, cause an accident and injure yourself and others.
Do not switch off the engine while driving.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
Move the selector lever to P.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
X
Shift to neutral N and release the clutch
pedal.
X Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
The engine is automatically switched off
and the ECO start/stop function is shown
in the multi-function display.
X
Automatic engine switch-off (ECO
start/stop function*)
The ECO start/stop function automatically
switches off the engine as soon as you stop
the vehicle, e.g. at traffic lights.
X Brake the vehicle until it comes to a standstill.
The shift instruction appears in the multifunction display.
Example illustration: ECO display
Vehicles with manual transmission
X
X
Shift to either first or reverse gear.
Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobiliser is activated.
* optional
Z
Example illustration: gearshift instruction
91
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 92
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Transmission
Transmission
Notes on the transmission
Manual transmission
5-speed manual transmission
G Risk of accident
Neutral Nwith ECO Start-Stop-Function*activated
The transmission must be in neutral N for the
engine to switch off when:
The movement of the pedals must not be
impaired in any way. Do not keep any
objects in the driver's footwell. Make sure
that floormats or carpets are correctly
secured and that there is sufficient clearance for the pedals.
X
G Risk of accident
! Only engage reverse gear when the vehi-
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This
could cause the drive wheels to lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid. This could
cause you to lose control of your vehicle
and cause an accident.
the engine is running below a certain
speed.
X the brake pedal is depressed.
X the clutch pedal is not depressed.
Engaging reverse gear
Vehicles without ECO Start-Stop-Function* (5speed manual transmission)
cle is stationary, otherwise the transmission could be damaged.
X
Move the gear lever to the right and then
back.
Vehicles with ECO Start-Stop-Function*
92
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 93
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Transmission
6-speed manual transmission
use the braking effect of the engine, so less
braking will be required to prevent the vehicle from gaining speed. This relieves the
load on the brake system and prevents the
brakes from overheating and wearing too
quickly.
Engaging reverse gear
! Only engage reverse gear when the vehicle is stationary, otherwise the transmission could be damaged.
Vehicles without ECO Start-Stop-Function* (6speed manual transmission)
! When shifting between 5th and 6th gear,
you should always push the gear lever all
the way to the right. You could otherwise
shift unintentionally into 3rd or 4th gear
and damage the transmission.
Do not exceed the maximum speed for the
individual gears.
If you shift down at too high a speed (transmission braking), this can cause the engine
to overrev, leading to engine damage.
X
Pull the gear lever up, move it to the left and
then back.
Gearshift indicator (BlueEFFICIENCY*vehicles)
i Observing the gearshift indicator in the
instrument cluster's multi-function display
will help you to improve the fuel economy
of your vehicle.
1 Upshift indicator
Shift up or down a gear when the corresponding indicator appears in the instrument cluster's multi-function display.
The shift indicator is meant as a recommendation for an economical driving style. However, always observe traffic conditions, as
your driving style is determined, in the first
instance, by the traffic situation.
X
! On long and steep downhill gradients,
especially when the vehicle is laden, you
must shift to a lower gear in time. This will
* optional
Z
93
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 94
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Transmission
Selector lever positions
AUTOTRONIC* (continuously variable
automatic transmission)
AUTOTRONIC is an electronically controlled,
continuously variable automatic transmission. The transmission ratio is changed continuously. This enables it to be ideally adapted
to your individual driving styles and to provide
increased driving comfort.
1 Drive program (C/S) or (C/S/M)*
2 Gear indicator
If you have selected one-touch gearshifting or
selector lever position D, you can see the currently engaged gear in the multi-function display.
You can influence the AUTOTRONIC transmission ratio when the selector lever is in
position D by changing gear yourself―see
One-touch gearshifting (Y page 95).
94
ì
Park position
Prevents the vehicle from rolling
away when stopped. Only move the
selector lever to P when the vehicle
is stationary.
The key can only be removed when
the selector lever is in position P. If
the key is removed from the ignition lock, the selector lever is
locked in position P.
í
Reverse gear
Only move the selector lever to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 95
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Transmission
ë
ê
Neutral
No power is transmitted from the
engine to the drive wheels. Releasing the brakes will allow you to
move the vehicle freely, e.g. to
push it or tow it.
If ESP® is deactivated or faulty:
only move the selector lever to N if
the vehicle is in danger of skidding,
e.g. on icy roads.
Drive
The transmission selects the optimum gear ratio automatically for
forward mode.
One-touch gearshifting (manual operation)
When the selector lever is in position D, you
can select the seven gears yourself.
Activating manual operation
X Press the selector lever lightly to the left
towards D- or to the right towards D+.
M is shown in the multi-function display.
Manual operation is activated.
X
To shift down: briefly press the selector
lever to the left towards D–.
The transmission shifts down to the next
gear, depending on the gear currently
selected.
i To prevent the engine from overrevving,
the transmission does not shift down if you
push the selector lever towards D– while
driving at too high a speed.
i AUTOTRONIC shifts down automatically if
the engine speed reaches the lower speed
range for the gear currently selected.
X
To shift up: briefly press the selector lever
to the right towards D+.
The transmission shifts up to the next gear,
depending on the gear currently selected.
i If the upper engine speed limit for the gear
currently engaged is reached and you continue to accelerate, AUTOTRONIC shifts up
automatically.
X
Deactivating manual operation
X Press and hold the selector lever towards
D+ until D is shown again in the multi-function display.
The transmission shifts from the current
gear to D.
Or:
X Briefly press the program selector button
next to the selector lever.
The letter for the last selected drive program C or S is shown again in the multifunction display. The transmission shifts
from the current gear to D.
i If you restart the engine and M manual
operation is selected, AUTOTRONIC shifts
into the automatic drive program C or S. If
automatic drive program C or S has been
selected, the automatic transmission will
resume the relevant drive program when
you restart the engine.
To select the ideal gear: press and hold
the selector lever to the left towards D–.
The transmission will shift to a range which
allows ideal acceleration and deceleration.
To do this, the transmission will shift down
one or more gears.
Z
95
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 96
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Transmission
Program selector button
The button is on the lower section of the
centre console.
Rthe
vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward and reverse gears, unless the
accelerator pedal is depressed fully.
Ran
increase in traction: this improves the
driving stability of the vehicle on slippery
road surfaces, for example.
Rthe
transmission shifting up sooner: the
vehicle is driven at lower engine speeds
and the wheels are less likely to spin.
Driving tips
1 Program selector button
C Comfort
comfortable driving style
S Sport
sporty driving style
The selected drive program (C/S) is shown in
the multi-function display (Y page 94).
X Press program selector button 1 repeatedly until the letter for the desired drive
program appears in the multi-function display (Y page 94).
Comfort mode C is characterised by the following:
96
Accelerator pedal position
Your style of driving influences how AUTOTRONIC shifts gear:
Rlittle throttle: early upshifts
Rmore
throttle: late upshifts
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
X Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The transmission shifts to a lower gear
depending on the engine speed.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
The transmission shifts back up.
Trailer towing
X Drive in the middle of the engine speed
range on uphill gradients.
X Shift down to 3rd or 2nd gear depending
on the incline of the uphill or downhill gradient(Y page 95), even if cruise control is
activated.
Working on the vehicle
G Risk of accident
Apply the handbrake and move the selector
lever to P when working on the vehicle.
Otherwise, the vehicle could roll away.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 97
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Instrument cluster
Instrument cluster
Points to remember
Activating the multi-function display
X
Switch on the ignition.
X
You will find an illustration of the instrument
cluster in the "At a glance" section
(Y page 26).
G Risk of accident
No further messages can be displayed if the
instrument cluster and/or the multi-function display fails.
This means that you will not see information
about the driving situation, such as the
speed, outside temperature, warning/indicator lamps, display messages or system
failures. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected. Adjust your driving
style and speed accordingly.
Immediately consult a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the
work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Adjusting the instrument cluster
lighting
Brighter or dimmer: briefly turn reset button 1 clockwise or anti-clockwise to the
stop and release.
The brightness of the instrument cluster
lighting changes by one level. There are
several possible levels.
Coolant temperature gauge
The multi-function display is also activated
when you:
Rswitch
on the lights
Rpress
reset button 1
Ropen
the driver's door
The coolant temperature gauge is in the
instrument cluster on the left-hand side.
Under normal operating conditions and with
the specified coolant level, the coolant temperature may rise to 120 †. The coolant temperature may rise to the top end of the scale
at high outside temperatures and on long
uphill stretches.
Z
97
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 98
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Resetting the trip meter
Select the Standard display menu
(Y page 103).
X Press and hold the reset button on the lefthand side of the instrument cluster until the
trip meter is reset.
X
Rev counter
The red band in the rev counter indicates the
engine's overrevving range. The fuel supply is
interrupted to protect the engine when the
red band is reached.
! Do not drive in the overrevving range.
Doing so will damage the engine.
H Environmental note
Avoid driving at high engine speeds, as this
increases your vehicle's consumption
unnecessarily and pollutes the environment through increased emissions.
98
Clock
On vehicles without an audio system or with
Audio 5*/Audio 20*, you can set the time
using the on-board computer (Y page 109).
Outside temperature display
G Risk of accident
The road surface may be icy, especially in
wooded areas or on bridges, even if temperatures are just above freezing point. The
vehicle could skid if you fail to adapt your
driving style. You should therefore always
adapt your driving style and speed to suit
the weather conditions.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
On-board computer
Points to remember
The on-board computer is activated as soon
as you turn the key to position 1 in the ignition
lock. You can use the on-board computer to
call up information relating to your vehicle
and to make and adjust settings.
G Risk of accident
Only use the on-board computer when road
and traffic conditions permit. You would
otherwise be distracted and unable to concentrate properly on driving, and could
cause an accident.
Multi-function steering wheel
You can control the multi-function display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multi-function steering
wheel.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 99
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
4
jk
Scrolls back/forth within a menu
j k Audio 20*, Audio 50
APS* and COMAND APS*:
Press and hold: in the Audio*/
DVD* menu, selects the next/previous station or selects an audio track
using rapid scrolling.
In the Telephone* menu: starts
rapid scrolling through the phone
book.
j k Audio 5*:
Press briefly: in the Audio* menu,
selects an audio track or, depending
on the settings, selects a stored or
the next/previous station.
1
Multi-function display
2
æç
RSelects submenus in the Settings menu
RChanges
RAdjusts
3
values
the volume
st
Accepts or rejects/ends a call*
* optional
j k Audio 20*, Audio 50
APS* and COMAND APS*:
Press briefly: in the Audio*/
DVD*menu, selects a stored station,
an audio track or a video scene*.
In the Telephone* menu: switches
to the phone book and selects a
name or a telephone number.
5
èÿ
Selects a menu: scrolls back and
forth
Several functions are combined thematically
in the menus.
In the Audio*/DVD* menu you will find functions used to operate the radio* or CD
player*, for instance. The functions can be
used either to call up information or to change
settings for your vehicle.
You can think of the configuration of the
menus and the functions within a menu as a
circle:
X Press the è or ÿ button repeatedly
to call up individual menus in sequence.
X Press the k or j button to call up
the functions within a menu.
99
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 100
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Unlike other menus, the Settings menu contains a number of submenus (Y page 106).
Multi-function display
Values, settings and display messages are
shown in the multi-function display.
1 Display area for menus or submenus
2 Status bar with outside temperature or
speed (Y page 108)
100
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 101
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Menus and submenus
Z
101
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 102
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Function
Function
1 Operation menu (Y page 102)
Rtrip meter and total distance
recorder (standard display)
(Y page 103)
Rtyre
pressure loss warning
(Y page 179)
Rdigital speedometer or outside tem-
perature (Y page 103)
RASSYST
PLUS service interval display (Y page 191)
REngine
player* (Y page 104)
Raudio
drive or
media* (Y page 104)
RDVD
video* (Y page 105)
3 Navigation* menu (NAV)
(Y page 105)
10 The
102
5 Settings menu (Y page 106)
Rresetting to factory settings
(Y page 106)
Rselecting
submenus (Y page 107)
6 Trip computer menu (Y page 112)
Rconsumption statistics
(Y page 112)
Rrange (Y
oil level* (Y page 173)
2 Audio*/DVD*menu (Y page 103)
Rradio station (Y page 103)
RCD
4 Message memory10 menu (Display
messages) (Y page 106)
page 113)
7 Telephone* menu (Y page 113)
The number of menus shown depends on the
optional equipment in the vehicle.
The generic terms in the table overview are
intended to help you navigate through the
menus. The terms themselves are not always
displayed in the multi-function display.
For the Audio 5*, the on-board computer displays the Audio* and Telephone* menus in
English. The language for these menus is not
dependent on the language selected for the
multi-function display.
Audio 20*, Audio 50 APS* and COMAND
APS*:
Depending on the audio system* fitted, the
Audio*, Navigation* and Telephone*
menus are slightly different. The examples
given in this Owner's Manual apply to vehicles
equipped with COMAND APS*.
Operation menu
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
X Press the è or · button to select the
standard display.
You can select the following functions in the
Operation menu by pressing the j or
k button:
Rtrip
meter and total distance recorder
(standard display)
Rtyre
pressure loss warning (Y page 179)
Rdigital
ture
speedometer or outside tempera-
menu is only visible when there is a display message.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 103
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
RASSYST
Selecting a radio station
Rengine
You can only store new stations using the
audio system* or COMAND APS* (see separate operating instructions).
PLUS service interval display
(Y page 191)
oil level* (Y page 173)
Standard display
Switch on the audio system* or COMAND
APS* and select Radio (see separate operating instructions).
X Use the è or · button to select the
Audio/DVD menu.
X
Digital speedometer (example)
X
1 Trip meter
2 Total distance
Displaying the digital speedometer or
outside temperature
If you have selected the digital speedometer
for the status line (Y page 108), select the
outside temperature display here11.
Press the j or k button to select
digital speedometer 1 or the outside temperature.
Audio*/DVD* menu
Audio 5*:
X
Press the j or k button to select the
desired station.
The type of search depends on the radio
station selection settings (Y page 111).
The next stored station is selected, or the
station search starts.
Use the functions in the Audio/DVD menu to
operate the audio equipment* or COMAND
APS*.
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
Z
11 Vehicles
for the United Kingdom: the outside temperature is displayed permanently.
* optional
103
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 104
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Audio 20*, Audio 50 APS*or COMAND
APS*:
To select a stored station: briefly press
the j or k button.
X To select a channel from the channel
list: press and hold the j or k button.
X To select a station using the station
search (only if no station list is received):
press and hold the j or k button.
X
i DAB* radio mode13 (Digital Audio Broadcasting) (see separate operating instructions).
Operating the CD player (Audio 5*)
You can play MP3/WMA CDs in the
Audio 5* drive.
Switch on the audio system* and select the
CD player (see separate operating instructions).
X Press the è or · button to select the
Audio menu.
X Press the j or k button to select a
CD track.
X
CD player display (example)
1 Function (the CD number is also shown
with a CD changer*)
2 Current track
Operating the audio player or audio
media*(Audio 20*, Audio 50 APS*or
COMAND APS*)
1 Waveband12
2 Station
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment fitted in the vehicle.
X
Switch on the audio system* or COMAND
APS* and select the audio player or
12 When
13 Only
104
station ; has been stored, the memory position will also be displayed.
for certain countries.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 105
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
medium (see separate operating instructions).
X Use the è or · button to select the
Audio/DVD menu.
X To select next/previous track: briefly
press the j or k button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the
j or k button.
Operating the DVD video*
Switch on COMAND and select DVD video
(see separate operating instructions).
X Use the è or · button to select the
Audio/DVD menu.
X Press the j or k button to select a
scene.
X
Navigation* menu
In the Navigation menu, the navigation
instructions from the navigation system
appear in the multi-function display.
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
X Press the è or ÿ button to select the
Navigation menu.
X Switch on the audio system* or COMAND
APS* (see separate operating instructions).
Route guidance inactive
CD changer display (example)
1 Current CD (for CD/DVD changer*)
DVD changer display (example)
1 Current DVD (for DVD changer*)
2 Current scene
2 Current track
The current track will not be displayed in
audio AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external audio source connected).
Z
Direction of travel display (example)
* optional
105
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 106
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
The direction of travel 1 appears in the multifunction display.
Route guidance active
The multi-function display shows navigation
instructions, for example:
Message memory menu
Previous display messages can be called up
in the Message memory menu. The Message memory menu is visible only when
there is a display message.
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Press the è or · button repeatedly
until either the original menu or the Message memory menu appears.
When there are display messages, 2 messages appears in the multi-function display, for example.
X Use the j or k button to scroll
through the display messages.
X
G Risk of accident
The on-board computer only records and
displays messages and warnings from certain systems. For this reason, you should
always make sure that your vehicle is safe
to drive. You could otherwise cause an accident by driving an unsafe vehicle.
i All possible display messages are
explained in the "Practical advice" section
(Y page 202).
Switching off the ignition clears all display
messages except for the highest priority display messages. When the causes of the highpriority display messages are rectified, these
display messages will be erased.
Displaying messages
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
106
Settings menu
In the Settings menu, you will find the Settings To reset Press reset button for
3 seconds function, with which you can
restore most settings to the factory settings.
You will also find submenus with which you
can make individual settings for your vehicle.
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
Resetting to factory settings
For safety reasons, not all functions will be
reset: permanent Speedtronic* can only be
set in the Vehicle submenu. The Settings
Headlamps function in the Lighting sub* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 107
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
menu will only be reset if the vehicle is stationary.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press and hold the reset button on the left
of the instrument cluster for approximately
three seconds.
A prompt appears in the multi-function display asking you to confirm by pressing the
reset button again.
X Press the reset button again.
The functions of most submenus are
restored to factory settings.
or
X If you want to retain the settings, do not
press the reset button a second time.
The Settings menu appears again after
approximately 5 seconds.
X Press the è or · button to select a
different menu.
Submenus in the Settings menu
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
A list of submenus is displayed. The list
contains more submenus than can be displayed at the same time.
X
Press the æ or ç button to change
the setting.
The changed setting is stored.
X Press the è or ÿ button to select a
different display.
The following tables show the settings you
can make in the individual submenus. You will
find additional information on the pages
shown.
X
Instrument cluster submenu
RUnit
of measurement for distance
(Y page 108)
RLanguage (Y
RStatus
page 108)
line display (Y page 108)
Time/date submenu14
Press the æ or ç button to select a
submenu.
The selected submenu is highlighted.
X Press the j button to select a function
within the submenu.
X
RTime
and date (Y page 109)
Z
14 This
function is not available on vehicles with Audio 50 APS* or COMAND APS*.
* optional
107
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 108
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Lighting submenu
RConstant
headlamp mode (daytime driving lights) (Y page 109)
RSurround
lighting* (Y page 110)
RExterior
lighting delayed switch-off*
(Y page 110)
RInterior
lighting delayed switch-off
(Y page 110)
Vehicle submenu
RPermanent
RRadio
Speedtronic* (Y page 120)
station selection *(Y page 111)
RAutomatic
locking feature (Y page 111)
Convenience submenu*
RFold
the exterior mirrors in when locking
the vehicle* (Y page 111)
15 Vehicles
108
Selecting the unit of measurement for
distance
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rthe
total distance recorder and the trip
meter
Rthe
trip computer
Rthe
digital speedometer15
Rthe
navigation instruction in the Navigation* menu
RSpeedtronic*
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the j button to select Display
unit Speed/odom.
X Press æ or ç to select km (kilometres) or miles as the unit of measurement
for distance.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
Selecting the language
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Inst. cluster submenu.
X Press the j button to select Language.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
desired language.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
X
Selecting the status line display
Vehicles for the United Kingdom: this function is not available.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Instr. cluster submenu.
X Press the j button to select Status
line display.
for the United Kingdom: the digital speedometer always displays km/h.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 109
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Press the æ or ç button to select the
status line display: outside temperature
(Outside temp.) or speed (Speed).
The selected display now appears constantly in the lower multi-function display.
When you scroll through the Operation
menu (Y page 102), you will see the display
you have not selected.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Setting the date and time
Your vehicle may be equipped with one of the
following audio systems*:
A: Audio 5* or Audio 20*
B: Audio 50 APS*
C: COMAND APS*
You can see which audio system* is fitted
in your vehicle by referring to the separate
operating instructions.
Depending on the audio system*, the time
and date are received from GPS satellites and
cannot be set using the on-board computer
(see the following table).
X
* optional
A B C
Set using the on-board computer
Automatic GPS satellite reception
X
X X
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Time/Date submenu.
X
Setting the time
Press the j button to select Time
Hours (or Time Minutes).
X Press the æ or ç button to set a
value.
X
Setting the date
Press the j button to select Date Set
day (or Date Set month or Date Set
year).
X Press the æ or ç button to set the
date.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Setting constant headlamp mode (daytime driving lights)
When you activate constant headlamp mode
and the light switch is set to M or U,
the parking lamps, dipped-beam headlamps
and licence plate lighting are switched on
automatically when the engine is running.
Turning the light switch to a different position
switches on the corresponding lights. Turn
the light switch to B or U first if you
wish to switch off constant headlamp mode
while driving in the dark.
In countries in which constant headlamp
mode is a legal requirement, Constant is the
factory setting.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
109
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 110
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Press the æ or ç button to select the
Lighting submenu.
X Press the j button to select Headlamp
mode.
X Press the æ or ç button to set the
switch-on mode for the headlamps to Manual or Constant (constant headlamp
mode).
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Switching the surround lighting*on/off
If the surround lighting is switched on, the
following lights will be switched on automatically in the dark after you have unlocked the
vehicle using the key:
Rthe
side lamps
Rthe
licence plate lighting
Rthe
front foglamps*
The surround lighting switches off automatically after 40 seconds or when the driver's
door is opened.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
110
Press the æ or ç button to select the
Lighting submenu.
X Press the j button to select Surround
lighting.
X Press the æ or ç button to switch
the Surround lighting on or off.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Activating or deactivating the exterior
lighting delayed switch-off*
When you activate the Headl. delayed
switch-off function, the exterior lighting
remains on for another 15 seconds after closing the doors when it is dark. If the engine is
switched off and then none of the doors are
opened, or if an open door is not closed, the
exterior lighting goes out after 60 seconds.
If you have activated the delayed switch-off
function and switched off the engine, the following remain lit:
Rthe
side lamps
Rthe
licence plate lighting
Rthe
front foglamps*
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Lighting submenu.
X Press the j button to select Headl.
delayed switch-off.
X Press the æ or ç button to activate
or deactivate the Headl. delayed
switch-off function.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
To temporarily deactivate the switch-off
delay:
X Before leaving the vehicle, turn the key to
position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock and back to position 0.
Delayed switch-off is deactivated.
When you start the engine again, the switchoff delay is reactivated.
X
Activating/deactivating the interior
lighting delayed switch-off
If you remove the key from the ignition lock
while the Interior lighting delayed
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 111
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
switch off function is activated, the interior
lighting remains on for 10 seconds if it is dark.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Lighting submenu.
X Press the j button to select Inter.
lighting delay.sw.off.
X Press the æ or ç button to activate
or deactivate Inter. lighting
delay.sw.off.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
Setting the radio station selection*
This function is only available in conjunction
with Audio 5*.
The Audio Search allows you to set whether
a new station is searched for every time you
switch on the radio* or a previously stored
station is selected.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
* optional
Press the æ or ç button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press the j button to select Audio
search.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Frequency or Memory setting.
If the Frequency setting is selected, the
station search is started. If the Memory setting is selected, the next stored station is
selected.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Activating/deactivating the automatic
door locking feature
When you activate the Automatic door
locking function, your vehicle will be centrally locked above a speed of approx.
15 km/h.
i For more information on the automatic
door locking feature, see (Y page 61).
Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X
Press the j button to select Automatic
door lock.
X Press the æ or ç button to switch
the Automatic door lock feature on or
off.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
Activating or deactivating the Fold in
mirrors when locking*function
When you activate the Fold mirr. in when
locking function, the exterior mirrors are
folded in when the vehicle is locked. If you
unlock the vehicle and then open the driver's
or front-passenger door, the exterior mirrors
fold out again.
When you fold the exterior mirrors in using
the button on the door with the Fold in mirrors
when locking function activated (Y page 72),
the exterior mirrors do not fold out automatically. The exterior mirrors can then only be
folded out using the button on the door.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Settings menu.
X Press the j button to select submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Convenience submenu.
111
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
preflight
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 112
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Press è or · to select After
start.
X Press j or k to select After
reset.
Press the j button to select Fold in
mirrors when locking.
X Press the æ or ç button to activate
or deactivate Fold in mirrors when
locking.
X Press the j, è or ÿ button to
select a different display.
X
X
Trip computer menu
You can use the Trip computer menu to call
up or reset statistical data for your vehicle.
1 Distance
2 Time
i Please refer to the menu overview
3 Average speed
4 Average fuel consumption
You can select km or miles as the unit of
measurement for distance (Y page 108).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
The trip computer is automatically reset From
start when
Rthe ignition is switched off for more than
4 hours
(Y page 101).
Trip computer from start
The values refer to the start of the journey.
X
Press è or · to select After
start.
112
R999
hours have been exceeded
R9999
kilometres have been exceeded
Trip computer from reset
The values refer to the last reset of the function.
1 Distance
2 Time
3 Average speed
4 Average fuel consumption
The trip computer is automatically reset From
reset if the trip exceeds 9,999 hours or
99,999 kilometres.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 113
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Resetting
Using è or ·, select From start.
X Press the j or k button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press and hold the reset button on the left
of the instrument cluster until the values
have reverted to "0".
X
Telephone menu*
Functions and displays depend on the
optional equipment installed in your vehicle.
You can place your mobile phone in the
mobile phone bracket* (Y page 164), or set
up a Bluetooth connection to the audio system* or COMAND APS* (see separate operating instructions).
Calling up the range
G Risk of accident
Using è or ·, select From start.
X Press the j or k button to select
Range:.
The multi-function display shows the estimated range of the vehicle, based on the
current driving style and the fuel level. If
there is only a small amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank, a vehicle refuelling
¿ appears instead of the range.
You must observe the legal requirements
for the country in which you are currently
driving when operating a mobile phone in
the vehicle.
If it is permitted to operate a mobile phone
while the vehicle is in motion, only operate
it when road and traffic conditions permit.
You could otherwise be distracted from the
traffic conditions, cause an accident and
injure yourself and others.
X
i Please refer to the menu overview
(Y page 101).
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
Switch on the mobile phone and audio
equipment* or COMAND APS* (see separate operating instructions).
X Press the è or · button to select the
Telephone menu.
X
Mobile phone on
PIN code not yet entered
Once you have inserted the mobile phone into
the mobile phone bracket*, the multi-function display shows the PIN display message.
X Enter the PIN using the mobile phone, Linguatronic*, the audio system* or COMAND
APS*.
The mobile phone will search for a network.
Mobile phone operational
You will see Ready or the name of the mobile
phone network provider in the multi-function
display. If the operational readiness symbol
of the mobile phone goes out, your vehicle is
outside the transmission and reception
range. In this case you will see No Service
in the multi-function display.
Z
* optional
113
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 114
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
On-board computer
Accepting a call
If you receive a call while you are in the Telephone menu, the multi-function display
shows a display message, for example.
Press the s button to accept the call.
You can still answer a call if you are not in the
Telephone menu.
X
Rejecting or ending a call
Press the t button.
You can still reject or end a call if you are not
in the Telephone menu.
X
Dialling a number from the phone book
You can enter new telephone numbers via the
mobile phone in the phone book (see sepa-
114
rate operating instructions). If your mobile
phone is operational, you can select and dial
a number from the phone book at any time.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Telephone menu.
X Press the j or k button to call up
the phone book.
X Press the j or k button to select the
desired name. To scroll rapidly, press and
hold the j or k button for longer
than 1 second.
X Press the s button to start dialling.
The Connecting call... message
appears in the multi-function display.
The number dialled is stored in the redial
memory.
The multi-function display shows the dialled telephone number. If the name is stored
in the phone book, it is shown instead of
the telephone number.
or
X If you do not want to make a call, press the
t button.
Redialling
The on-board computer stores the most
recently dialled names and numbers from the
redial memory.
X Press the è or · button to select the
Telephone menu.
X Press the s button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the j or k button to select the
desired name or telephone number.
X Press the s button to start dialling.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 115
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Driving systems
Overview of driving systems
The vehicle's driving systems are described
on the following pages:
RCruise
control* and Speedtronic*, which
are used to control the speed of the vehicle
RParktronic*
and active parking assist*,
which can help you to find a parking space,
to manoeuvre and park
RECO
Start-Stop function*, helps you to
save fuel
The ABS, BAS, adaptive brake lights, ESP®
and STEER CONTROL driving safety systems
are described in the "Driving safety systems"
section (Y page 55).
Cruise control*
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. You must select a low gear in
good time on long and steep downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer. By doing so you will make use of
the braking effect of the engine, which
relieves the load on the brake system and
prevents the brakes from overheating and
wearing too quickly.
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously while the vehicle is in motion, e.g.
never cause the brakes to rub by applying
constant slight pedal pressure. This causes
the brake system to overheat, increases
the braking distance and can lead to the
brakes failing completely.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This
could cause the drive wheels to lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
store any road speed above 30 km/h.
* optional
G Risk of accident
Cruise control cannot take account of road
and traffic conditions.
Always pay attention to traffic conditions
even when cruise control is activated.
Cruise control is only an aid designed to
assist driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed and for braking in good
time.
G Risk of accident
Do not use cruise control:
Rin road and traffic conditions which do
not allow you to maintain a constant
speed (e.g. heavy traffic or winding
roads). You could otherwise cause an
accident.
Ron
slippery roads. Braking or accelerating could cause the drive wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid.
Rwhen
there is poor visibility, e.g. due to
fog, heavy rain or snow
Cruise control lever
You can operate cruise control and variable
Speedtronic with the cruise control lever.
115
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 116
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off:
cruise control is selected
RLIM
indicator lamp lit:
variable Speedtronic is selected
Selecting cruise control
X
When selecting another gear, press the
accelerator pedal slightly to increase the
smoothness of the gear change.
When you depress the clutch pedal and
change to another gear, the engine speed
can increase slightly while no gear is selected.
Ralways drive at adequate, but not excessive, engine speeds.
Check whether LIM indicator lamp 2 is off.
If it is off, cruise control is already selected.
If it is on, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow 5.
LIM indicator lamp 2 in the cruise control
lever goes out. Cruise control is selected.
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
1 To store the current speed or a higher
speed
2 LIM indicator lamp
3 Calling up the last speed stored
4 To store the current speed or a lower
speed
5 To switch between cruise control and var-
iable Speedtronic
6 Deactivating cruise control
116
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 30 km/h.
X Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up
1 or down 4.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
the stored speed on uphill and downhill
gradients. The stored speed is resumed
when the gradient levels out.
Vehicles with manual transmission:
Rchange
gear in good time.
Rif
possible, do not change down several
gears at a time.
Calling up the last speed stored
G Risk of accident
Only select a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and whether it is suitable for
the current situation. Otherwise, sudden
acceleration or braking could endanger you
or others.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you 3.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated and adjusts the
vehicle's speed to the last speed stored.
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 117
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Setting a speed
Deactivating cruise control
Press the cruise control lever up 1 for a
higher speed or down 4 for a lower speed.
X Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is reached.
X Release the cruise control lever.
The new speed is stored.
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
or
X
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
i Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*:
When you decelerate the vehicle using the
cruise control lever, AUTOTRONIC changes
down if deceleration is insufficient.
Making fine adjustments in
1 km/hincrements
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up
1 for a higher speed or down 4 for a
lower speed.
The last speed stored is increased or
reduced.
* optional
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards 6.
or
X
Brake.
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow 5.
Variable Speedtronic is selected. LIM indicator lamp 2 in the cruise control lever
lights up.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if,
for example:
X
Raquaplaning
is detected
Ryou
press the clutch pedal for more than
four seconds on vehicles with a manual
transmission
Ryou move the selector lever to N while driv-
ing in vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
Speedtronic*
Speedtronic is used to make sure that you do
not exceed a stored speed. You must select
a low gear in good time on long and steep
downhill gradients, especially if the vehicle is
laden or towing a trailer. By doing so you will
make use of the braking effect of the engine,
which relieves the load on the brake system
and prevents the brakes from overheating
and wearing too quickly.
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously while the vehicle is in motion, e.g.
never cause the brakes to rub by applying
constant slight pedal pressure. This causes
the brake system to overheat, increases
the braking distance and can lead to the
brakes failing completely.
G Risk of accident
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This
could cause the drive wheels to lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid.
switch off the engine.
Z
117
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 118
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
You can set a variable or permanent limit
speed:
Rvariable
areas
for speed limits, e.g. in built-up
variable Speedtronic is selected
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
Rpermanent
for long-term speed restrictions, e.g. for driving on winter tyres
(Y page 120)
G Risk of accident
Speedtronic is only an aid designed to
assist driving. You are responsible for the
vehicle's speed and for braking in good
time.
i The speed indicated in the speedometer
may differ slightly from the limit speed
stored.
Variable Speedtronic*
You can operate cruise control and variable
Speedtronic with the cruise control lever.
The LIM indicator lamp on the cruise control
lever indicates which system you have selected:
RLIM
indicator lamp off:
cruise control is selected
RLIM
118
Selecting variable Speedtronic
X
Check whether LIM indicator lamp 2 is on.
If it is on, variable Speedtronic is already
selected.
If it is not, press the cruise control lever in
the direction of arrow 5.
LIM indicator lamp 2 in the cruise control
lever lights up. Variable Speedtronic is
selected.
G Risk of accident
1 To store the current or higher speed, roun-
ded up to the nearest ten
2 LIM indicator lamp
3 To resume the last stored speed or to
make fine adjustments in 1 km/h increments
4 To store the current or lower speed, rounded down to the nearest ten
5 To switch between cruise control and variable Speedtronic
6 Deactivating variable Speedtronic
If there is a change of drivers, advise the
new driver of the limit speed stored.
Only use Speedtronic when you do not have
to accelerate suddenly to a speed higher
than the stored limit speed allows. You
could otherwise cause an accident.
You can only exceed the limit speed stored
if you deactivate variable Speedtronic:
Rusing
the cruise control lever
Rby
depressing the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown)
It is not possible to deactivate variable
Speedtronic by braking.
indicator lamp lit:
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 119
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Storing the current speed
You can use the cruise control lever to limit
the speed to any speed above 30 km/h while
the engine is running.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up
1 or down 4.
The current speed is stored. Speedtronic
rounds up or down to the nearest ten. You
will see the message "Limit" and the
stored speed in the upper multi-function
display for approximately five seconds. The
yellow LIM indicator lamp lights up in the
instrument cluster.
i On downhill gradients, the speed can be
exceeded despite Speedtronic. In this
case, you will hear a warning tone and the
Limit exceeded message will appear in
the multi-function display. If necessary,
apply the brakes yourself.
Calling up the last speed stored
G Risk of accident
Only select a stored speed if you know what
that speed is and whether it is suitable for
the current driving and traffic situation.
Otherwise, sudden braking could endanger
you or others.
X
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you 3.
Making adjustments in 10 km/hincrements
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever up
1 for a higher speed or down 4 for a
lower speed.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pressed until
the desired speed is set. Press the cruise
control lever, up 1 for a higher speed or
down 4 for a lower speed.
Making fine adjustments in
1 km/hincrements
X
For a higher speed: briefly pull the cruise
control lever towards you 3.
or
X
Keep the cruise control lever pulled
towards you 3 until the desired speed is
set.
Deactivating variable Speedtronic
There are several ways to deactivate variable
Speedtronic:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards 6.
or
Briefly press the cruise control lever in the
direction of arrow 5.
LIM indicator lamp 2 in the cruise control
lever goes out. Variable Speedtronic is
deactivated.
Cruise control is selected.
Variable Speedtronic is deactivated automatically when you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown), but
only if your current speed does not differ by
more than 20 km/h from the stored speed.
X
G Risk of accident
It is not possible to deactivate variable
Speedtronic by braking.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the engine.
Z
119
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 120
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Permanent Speedtronic*
Parktronic*
You can use the on-board computer to limit
the speed permanently to a value between
160 km/h (e.g. for driving with winter tyres)
and the maximum speed.
Just before the stored speed is reached, it
appears in the multi-function display.
You cannot exceed the stored limit speed,
even if you depress the accelerator pedal
beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
G Risk of accident
Setting permanent Speedtronic
Press è or · to select the Settings menu (Y page 106).
X Press the j button to call up the selection of submenus.
X Press the æ or ç button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press j to select Speed limit
(tyres).
X
X
120
Press the æ or ç button to select the
desired setting.
The following settings can be selected:
ROff
Permanent Speedtronic is deactivated.
RA
limit speed between 230 km/h and
160 km/h in increments of 10 km/h
X
To select a different display, press the
j, è or ÿ button.
Parktronic is only an aid and may not detect
all obstacles. It is not a substitute for attentive driving.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your
immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that no persons or animals are
in the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
Parktronic is an electronic parking aid using
ultrasound. It indicates visually and audibly
the distance between your vehicle and an
object.
Parktronic is automatically activated when
you switch on the ignition and release the
handbrake.
Parktronic is deactivated at speeds above
18 km/h. It is reactivated at lower speeds.
Parktronic monitors the area around your
vehicle using six sensors in the front bumper
and four sensors in the rear bumper.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 121
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic
car wash, a lorry's compressed-air brakes
or a pneumatic drill could cause Parktronic
to malfunction.
Minimum distance
1 Example: sensors in the front bumper,
left-hand side
Top view
Front sensors
Range of the sensors
Centre
Approximately 100 cm
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and
slush, otherwise they may not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 196).
Corners
Approximately 80 cm
Rear sensors
Centre
Approximately 120 cm
Corners
Approximately 80 cm
! When parking, pay particular attention to
Side view
Centre
Approximately 20 cm
Corners
Approximately 20 cm
If there is an obstacle within this range, all
warning displays light up and a tone sounds.
If the distance falls below the minimum clearance, it may no longer be shown.
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the centre air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the roof lining in the rear compartment.
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer towbars. Parktronic
does not detect such objects when they are
in the immediate vicinity of the vehicle. You
could damage the vehicle or the objects.
Z
121
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 122
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Manual transmission:
Front area warning display
1 Left-hand side of the vehicle
2 Right-hand side of the vehicle
3 Indicator segments
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red segments. Parktronic is operational if yellow indicator segments 3 light up.
The gear lever or selector lever position*
determines which warning display is active:
Gear lever in
Warning display
Forwards gear
or
Neutral
Front area activated
Reverse gear
Rear and front areas
activated
AUTOTRONIC*:
Selector lever at
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R orN
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
two seconds. You have reached the minimum distance.
RRear area: from the sixth segment onwards,
you will hear an intermittent warning tone.
At the seventh segment, you will hear a
continuous warning tone for a maximum of
two seconds. You have reached the minimum distance. The continuous warning
tone is muted immediately if you shift out
of reverse gear on vehicles with manual
transmission or if you select D or P on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*.
Deactivating/activating Parktronic
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance to the obstacle.
RFront
area: following the sixth segment,
you will hear an intermittent warning tone,
after the seventh segment, you will hear a
continuous warning tone for a maximum of
1 Deactivating/activating Parktronic
2 Indicator lamp
If indicator lamp 2 is on, Parktronic is deactivated.
122
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 123
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
i Parktronic is automatically activated
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Trailer towing*
Parktronic is deactivated for the rear area
when you establish an electrical connection
between your vehicle and a trailer.
! Remove the detachable trailer coupling if
it is no longer required. Parktronic measures the minimum detection range to an
obstacle from the bumper, not the ball coupling.
Active parking assist*
Active parking assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. Ultrasound is used to
measure the road on both sides of the vehicle.
A suitable parking space is indicated by the
parking symbol. Active steering intervention
can assist you during parking. You may also
use Parktronic (Y page 120). When Parktronic
is deactivated, active parking assist is also
unavailable.
G Risk of accident
Active parking assist is merely an aid and
may sometimes recommend parking
spaces that are not suitable for parking.
These might be, for example, spaces where
parking is prohibited, driveways, unsuitable
surfaces, etc.
Active parking assist measures the parking
space as you drive past it. Any later
changes to the parking space are not taken
into account. This may be the case, for
instance, when the vehicle parked in front
of or behind the space changes its position
or when an obstacle is moved into the parking space.
Active parking assist does not relieve you
of the responsibility of paying attention. If
you rely solely on Active parking assist, you
could cause an accident and injure yourself
and others.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your
immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring.
G Risk of accident
Objects located above the height range of
Active parking assist will not be detected
* optional
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking procedure is calculated, e. g. overhanging loads, tail sections or loading ramps of
goods vehicles. In some circumstances,
Active parking assist may therefore guide
you into the parking space too early. This
may lead to a collision. For this reason, you
should avoid using Active parking assist in
such situations.
G Risk of accident
The front of the vehicle will veer out in the
direction of the oncoming traffic during the
parking operation. In some cases the vehicle will also take you onto sections of the
oncoming lane during the parking procedure.
You are responsible for safety at all times
and must pay attention to any road users
approaching or passing. Stop the vehicle if
necessary or cancel the Active parking
assist parking procedure.
G Risk of injury
Make sure that no persons or animals are
in the manoeuvring range. Otherwise, they
could be injured.
Z
123
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 124
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Use Active parking assist for parking spaces
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel.
Rthat
are on straight roads, not bends.
Rthat
are on the same level as the road, i.e.
not on the pavement, for example;
Parking tips:
ROn narrow roads, drive as close to the park-
ing space as possible.
RParking
spaces which are littered, overgrown or partially occupied by trailer towbars might not be identified properly.
RSnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
RPay
attention to the Parktronic warning
messages during the parking procedure
(Y page 121).
RYou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active parking
assist will then be cancelled.
RWhen
transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle you should not use Active
parking assist.
RNever use active parking assist when snow
chains or an emergency spare wheel* are
fitted.
124
RMake
sure that the tyre pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it as well as the condition
of the location. In some cases, Active parking assist may guide you too far into a parking space, or not far enough into it. In some
cases it may also lead you across or onto
the kerb. If necessary, you should abort the
parking procedure with Active parking
assist.
RYou
can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space Should
a gear be changed too early to achieve a
sensible parking position, the parking procedure will be aborted.
! When unavoidable, you should drive over
Detecting parking spaces
Active parking assist is switched on automatically when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
35 km/h. While in operation, the system independently locates and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle. When
driving at speeds below 35 km/h, you will see
the parking symbol as a status indicator in the
instrument cluster. Active parking assist only
displays parking spaces on the frontpassenger side as standard. Parking spaces
on the driver's side are displayed as soon as
the turn signal on the driver's side is activated. If you wish to park in a space on the driver's side, the indicator on the driver's side
must remain on. This must remain switched
on until you acknowledge the use of Active
parking assist by pressing the j button on
the multi-function steering wheel.
When a parking space has been detected, an
arrow towards the right or the left also
appears.
obstacles such as kerbs slowly and not at
a sharp angle. Otherwise you may damage
the wheel rims or tyres.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 125
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Parking
X
G Risk of accident
Example: Parking space detected
1 Detected parking space on the left
2 Parking symbol
3 Detected parking space on the right
Active parking assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel.
Rthat
are at least 1.5 m wide.
Rthat
are at least 1.3 m longer than your
vehicle.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approx. 15 m
away from it.
Parktronic and Active parking assist are
merely parking aids and may not detect all
obstacles. They do not relieve you of the
responsibility of paying attention.
You are always responsible for safety and
must continue to pay attention to your
immediate surroundings when parking and
manoeuvring. You could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
Stop the vehicle when the parking space
symbol shows the desired parking space in
the instrument cluster.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: Shift to
reverse gear.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*: move the
selector lever to position R.
On the multi-function display, the message:
Park Assist Activate? Check vehicle surroundings Yes: No: appears
X
To cancel the procedure: press the k
button on the multi-function steering wheel
or pull away.
or
X
To park using active parking assist: press
the j button on the multi-function
steering wheel.
On the multi-function display, the message:
Park Assist active Please accelerate and brake the vehicle yourself
appears
G Risk of accident
When parking, you need to make sure that
no obstacles are located in the vicinity of
the vehicle during the entire operation.
Active parking assist does not relieve you
of the responsibility of paying attention. It
merely aids you by intervening actively in
the steering.
To stop the vehicle or avoid an accident you
need to apply the brakes yourself.
X
X
Let go of the multi-function steering wheel.
Reverse the car, being ready to brake at all
times. When reversing, do not exceed a
speed of approx.10 km/h, otherwise active
parking assist will be deactivated.
Z
* optional
125
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 126
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
the best parking results by reversing as far
as possible. When doing so, also observe
the Parktronic messages.
Stop as soon as Parktronic sounds the continuous warning tone, if not before.
Manoeuvring may be required in tight parking spaces.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the message Park Assist active Please shift
to a forward gear appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*: the message
Park Assist active Please shift to
D appears in the multi-function display.
X Vehicles with manual transmission: When
the car is stationary, shift to first gear.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*: When the car
is stationary, set the selector lever to position R.
Active parking assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
On the multi-function display, the message:
Park Assist active Please acceler-
ate and brake the vehicle yourself
appears.
i You will achieve the best parking results
by waiting for the steering procedure to
complete before moving forwards.
X
126
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as Parktronic sounds the continuous warning tone, if not before.
Vehicles with manual transmission: the message Park Assist active Please shift
into reverse gear appears in the multifunction display.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*, the message
Park Assist active Please shift to
R appears in the multi-function display.
X
Further gear changes* may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the message Parking assistance
finished Please take over appears.
Active parking assist is now deactivated.
Parktronic is still available.
X Manoeuvre if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by Parktronic (Y page 121).
X
Cancelling active parking assist
You can cancel active parking assist at any
time.
X Stop the movement of the multi-function
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active parking assist will be cancelled at
once. The multi-function display shows the
message: Park Assist cancelled.
or
X Press the Parktronic button on the centre
console (Y page 122).
Parktronic is switched off and active parking assist is immediately cancelled. The
multi-function display shows the message:
Park Assist cancelled.
Active parking assist is cancelled automatically if:
Ra
gear is changed* too early
Rparking
using active parking assist is no
longer possible
Ryou
are driving faster than 10 km/h
wheel spins, ESP® is activated or fails. In
such cases the v warning lamp lights
up in the instrument cluster.
Ra
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 127
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
A warning tone sounds. the multi-function
display shows the message: Park Assist
cancelled.
When active parking assist is cancelled, you
must steer again yourself.
Trailer towing*
For vehicles with a trailer coupling, the minimum length for parking spaces is slightly
increased.
If you have attached a trailer to your vehicle,
you should not use active parking assist.
Once the electrical connection is established
between your vehicle and the trailer, active
parking assist is no longer available. Parktronic is deactivated for the rear area.
ECO start/stop function*
The ECO start/stop function automatically
switches off the engine as soon as you stop
the vehicle and restarts the engine as soon as
you prepare to pull away again. Each time the
engine is started using the key, the ECO
start/stop function is activated.
Conditions for the automatic engine
switch-off
The ECO start/stop function automatically
switches off the engine if all of the following
conditions are met:
Rthe
battery is sufficiently charged
Rthe
brake vacuum is stable
Conditions for the automatic engine
start
The ECO start/stop function automatically
switches on the engine if one of the following
conditions is met:
Rthe
brake pedal is released
Rthe
clutch pedal is depressed
Rthe vehicle speed exceeds a certain thresh-
old
Ryou
have shifted to neutral
Rthe
ECO button is pressed
Rthe
clutch pedal is not depressed
Rthe
brake vacuum has decreased
brake pedal is depressed
Rthe
battery charge has dropped
vehicle speed is very low
Rthe
Rthe
Rthe
Rthe
engine has reached its operating temperature
demister function of Thermotronic* is
selected
Rthe
indicator lamp in the ECO button is lit
green
Rthe
bonnet is closed
Rthe
outside temperature is within the comfort range
Z
* optional
127
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 128
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Driving systems
Activating/deactivating the ECO start/
stop function
If indicator lamp 2 is off, the ECO start/stop
function is deactivated. The engine will then
not be switched off automatically when the
vehicle stops.
i The next time that the engine is started
using the key, the ECO start/stop function
is automatically reactivated.
1 To activate/deactivate the ECO start/
stop function
2 Indicator lamp
128
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 129
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Air conditioning
Overview of air-conditioning systems
The vehicle is equipped with one of the following air-conditioning systems:
Heatmatic16
Air-conditioning system*
Thermotronic*
Heatmatic is a heating and ventilation system The air conditioning combines a heating and The Thermotronic automatic air-conditioning
without a cooling system.
ventilation system with a cooling system.
system combines an automatic heating and
ventilation system with a cooling system. You
can control the air conditioning separately for
the driver's and front-passenger sides.
Z
16 Only
in certain countries.
* optional
129
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 130
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
General notes
The air-conditioning system*/
Thermotronic* controls the temperature and
the humidity of the vehicle interior and filters
out undesirable substances from the air.
Heatmatic/the air-conditioning system*/
Thermotronic* is only operational when the
engine is running. Optimum operation is achieved only when you drive with the side windows and panorama louvred sliding sunroof* closed.
130
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 86). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and completely filters out pollen. A clogged filter reduces the amount of
air supplied to the vehicle interior. For this
reason, you should always observe the
interval for replacing the filter, which is
specified in the Service Booklet. As it
depends on environmental conditions, e.g.
heavy air pollution, the interval may be
shorter than stated in the Service Booklet.
G Risk of accident
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise mist up. This may obstruct your view
of the traffic situation, thereby causing an
accident.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 131
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Overview of air-conditioning system functions
Heatmatic
Function
1
Sets the temperature
Function
3
P Demists the windscreen
2
Sets the airflow
Switches the air conditioning on/
off
Ä Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
Function
5
Sets the air distribution
P Demists the windscreen
P Demists the windscreen
4
1 Switches the rear window
heating on/off
Z
131
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 132
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
i Notes and recommendations on optimum
air conditioning:
RActivate
the air conditioning by turning
control knob 3 clockwise to the desired
position (except position 0).
outside odours or when in a tunnel. Otherwise, the windows could mist up due
to a lack of fresh air in air-recirculation
mode.
ROnly
use the "demisting" function until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly
use the "air-recirculation mode"
briefly, e.g. when there are unpleasant
Air-conditioning system*
132
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 133
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Function
1
Sets the temperature
P Demists the windscreen
2
Ä Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
3
Sets the airflow
Switches the air conditioning on/
off
P Demists the windscreen
Function
4
1 Switches the rear window
heating on/off
5
Sets the air distribution
P Demists the windscreen
6
œ Switches cooling with air
dehumidification on/off
ROnly
use the "demisting" function until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly
use the "air-recirculation mode"
briefly, e.g. when there are unpleasant
outside odours or when in a tunnel. Otherwise, the windows could mist up due
to a lack of fresh air in air-recirculation
mode.
i Notes and recommendations on optimum
air conditioning:
RActivate
the air conditioning by turning
control knob 3 clockwise to the desired
position (except position 0).
RSet
the temperature to 22 †.
Z
133
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 134
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Thermotronic*
Function
Function
Function
1
Q Sets the airflow
5
8
2
U Controls the air conditioning
automatically
´ Switches the air conditioning
on/off
T Switches the residual heat
function on/off
6
9
Sets the air distribution
3
| Demists the windscreen
$ Increases the temperature,
right
$ Increases the temperature,
left
1 Switches the rear window
heating on/off
a
4
7
œ Switches cooling with air
dehumidification on/off
b
% Reduces the temperature,
right
134
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 135
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Function
c
Display
d
% Reduces the temperature, left
e
Ä Activates/deactivates airrecirculation mode
Switching the air conditioning on/off
i When the air conditioning is switched off,
the air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. Only select this setting briefly,
otherwise the windows may mist up.
i Activate the air conditioning primarily
using the U button.
i Notes and recommendations on optimum
air conditioning:
Heatmatic/air-conditioning system*
RActivate
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: turn thumbwheel 3 clockwise to the desired position (apart from the
0 position) (Y page 131), (Y page 132).
X To deactivate: turn thumbwheel 3 anticlockwise to position 0 (Y page 131),
(Y page 132).
the air conditioning using
the U and œ buttons. The indicator lamps on the U and œ buttons
light up.
RSet
the temperature to 22 †.
ROnly
use the "demisting" function until
the windscreen is clear again.
ROnly
use the "air-recirculation mode"
briefly, e.g. when there are unpleasant
outside odours or when in a tunnel. Otherwise, the windows could mist up due
to a lack of fresh air in air-recirculation
mode.
X
Thermotronic*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the ´ button.
The indicator lamp in the ´ button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again.
or
X Press the U button.
The indicator lamp in the U button
comes on. Airflow and air distribution are
set to automatic mode.
X To deactivate: press the ´ button.
The indicator lamp in the ´ button
comes on.
X
RYou
can use the residual heat to heat or
ventilate the vehicle interior after you
have switched off the ignition.
* optional
Z
135
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 136
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Switching cooling with air dehumidification on/off
The "cooling with dehumidification" function
is only available when the engine is running.
The air inside the vehicle is cooled and dehumidified according to the temperature selected. This prevents the windows from misting
up.
G Risk of accident
If the "cooling with air dehumidification"
function is deactivated, the air inside the
vehicle will not be cooled (during warm
weather) or dehumidified. The windows
could mist up more quickly. This may prevent you from observing the traffic conditions, thereby causing an accident.
H Environmental note
The cooling system uses the refrigerant
R134A. This refrigerant does not damage
the earth's ozone layer.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when Thermatic is in cooling
mode.
The "cooling with air dehumidification" function is only available with air conditioning* or
Thermotronic*.
17 Vehicles
136
To switch on: press the œ button.
The indicator lamp in the œ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the œ button.
The indicator lamp in the œ button goes
out. The cooling with air dehumidification
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the U button.
The indicator lamp in the U button
comes on. Automatic air distribution and
airflow are activated.
X
X
Controlling the air conditioning automatically
Only Thermotronic* features the "control air
conditioning automatically" function.
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic air conditioning will achieve
optimal operation if "cooling with air dehumidification" is also activated. If necessary,
cooling with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
To deactivate: press the U button.
The indicator lamp in the U button goes
out. The airflow is regulated to the level set.
The air distribution is set to the b position.
Setting the temperature
Heatmatic/air-conditioning system*
You can set the temperature for the entire
vehicle.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn thumbwheel 1 clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 131), (Y page 132). Only adjust the
temperature in small increments. Start at
22 †.17
with air conditioning*
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 137
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
ice, snow and foliage, to guarantee the supply of fresh air into the vehicle interior.
Thermotronic*
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
X Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: press the $ or
% button. Only change the temperature
setting in small increments. Start at 22 †.
The temperature is shown in the display.
Rnever cover the vents or air inlet and outlet
grilles in the vehicle interior.
i Position the sliders for the centre air
vents in the central detent position for virtually draught-free ventilation.
Setting the centre air vents
Adjusting the air vents
X
G Risk of injury
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the
air vents. This could cause burns or frostbite to bare skin in the immediate vicinity
of the vents. Keep bare skin away from
these air outlets. If necessary, direct the
airflow away to a different area of the vehicle interior.
Please observe the following notes to ensure
that the air can flow freely through the air
vents:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windscreen
and the bonnet free of deposits, such as
* optional
Adjusting the side air vents
To open/close: turn thumbwheel 3 up or
down.
i Demister vent 1 is never shut com-
pletely, even if side air vent 2 is shut.
Setting the glove compartment air
vent*
1 Centre air vent, left
2 Centre air vent, right
3 Thumbwheel for centre air vent, right
4 Thumbwheel for centre air vent, left
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheels 3 and
4 up or down.
The glove compartment can be ventilated, for
instance, to cool its contents, when the air
conditioning*/Thermotronic* is activated.
The level of airflow depends on the airflow and
air distribution settings.
! Close the glove compartment air vent
when heating mode is activated. Open the
air vent and activate "cooling with air dehu-
137
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 138
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
midification" if the outside temperature is
high. Otherwise, temperature-sensitive
items stored in the glove compartment
could be damaged.
Setting the rear-compartment air vents
Setting the air distribution
Heatmatic/air-conditioning system*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn thumbwheel 5 to the corresponding
symbol (Y page 131), (Y page 132). The
thumbwheel can also be turned to the area
between two symbols.
X
Thermotronic*
1 Rear-compartment air vent, left
2 Rear-compartment air vent, right
1 Air vent thumbwheel
2 Air vent
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel 1
clockwise or anti-clockwise.
138
3 Thumbwheel for rear-compartment air
vents
X
To open/close: turn thumbwheel 3 to the
left or right.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Turn thumbwheel 9 to the corresponding
symbol (Y page 134). The thumbwheel can
also be turned to the area between two
symbols.
X
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 139
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Setting the airflow
Heatmatic/air-conditioning system*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn thumbwheel
3 clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 131), (Y page 132).
Demisting the windscreen
i You should only select the "demisting"
function until the windscreen is clear again.
X
Thermotronic*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To increase/reduce: turn thumbwheel
1 clockwise or anti-clockwise
(Y page 134).
X
Heatmatic/air-conditioning system*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: switch on the cooling with air
dehumidification.18
X Deactivate air-recirculation mode.
X Turn thumbwheel 1 clockwise to
P (Y page 131), (Y page 132).
X Turn thumbwheel 3 clockwise to
P (Y page 131), (Y page 132).
X Turn thumbwheel 5 clockwise or anticlockwise to P (Y page 131),
(Y page 132).
X
X
To deactivate: turn thumbwheels 1, 3
and 5 to the desired position (apart from
the P position) (Y page 131),
(Y page 132).
Thermotronic*
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the | button.
The indicator lamp in the | button
comes on.
The system automatically switches to the
following functions:
X
Rcooling
airflow
Rhigh
temperature
Rair
distribution to the windscreen and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation
X
mode off
To switch off: press the | button.
The indicator lamp in the | button goes
out. The previously selected settings come
into effect again. The cooling with air dehumidification function remains on. Air-recirculation mode remains deactivated.
or
X
18 Only
with air dehumidification on
Rhigh
Press the U button.
The indicator lamp in the | button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
vehicles with an air-conditioning system*
* optional
139
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 140
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
or
X
Press one of the $ or % temperature
buttons.
The indicator lamp in the | button goes
out. The air distribution is directed towards
the windscreen. The air conditioning
switches to manual mode.
or
X
Turn thumbwheel 1 clockwise or anticlockwise (Y page 134).
The indicator lamp in the | button goes
out. The air distribution is directed towards
the windscreen. The air conditioning
switches to manual mode.
Demisting the windows
Windows misted up on the inside
Activate the "cooling with air dehumidification" function19.
X Activate the automatic air conditioning.20
X If the windows continue to mist up, activate
the "demisting" function.
X
Switching the rear window heating
on/off
G Risk of accident
Clear all windows of ice or snow before setting off. Impaired visibility could otherwise
endanger you and others.
i The rear window heating has a high cur-
rent draw. You should therefore switch it
off as soon as the window is clear, as it only
switches off automatically after several
minutes.
Windows misted up on the outside
X
X
Activate the windscreen wipers.
Turn the air distribution thumbwheel to the
Y or a symbol.
i You should only select this setting until
the windscreen is clear again.
i If the battery voltage is too low, the rear
window heating may switch off.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate, press the 121/F22 button.
The indicator lamp in the 1/F button lights up or goes out.
X
19 Vehicles
with air conditioning*/Thermotronic*.
with Thermotronic*.
21 Vehicles with an air-conditioning system*/Thermotronic*.
22 Vehicles with Heatmatic.
20 Vehicles
140
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 141
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Air conditioning
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odours are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
G Risk of accident
Only switch over to air-recirculation mode
briefly at low outside temperatures. Otherwise, the windows could mist up, thus
impairing visibility and endangering yourself and others. This may prevent you from
observing the traffic conditions, thereby
causing an accident.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X To activate: press the Ä button.
The indicator lamp in the Ä button lights
up.
X
To deactivate: press the Ä button.
The indicator lamp in the Ä button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode switches off automatically:
Rafter
approximately five minutes at outside temperatures below approximately
7†
Rafter
approximately 5 minutes if cooling
with air dehumidification23 is switched
off
Rafter
approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
7†
window moves. If there is a risk of entrapment, press the Ä button again. Press
the button for stopping, opening or closing
the side windows in the opposite direction
as appropriate.
Make sure that nobody can become trapped as the panorama louvred sliding sunroof* is opened and closed. If there is a risk
of entrapment, press the Ä button
again. Press the button for stopping, opening or closing the panorama louvred sunroof* in the opposite direction as appropriate.
X
Convenience closing: press and hold
the Ä button until the side windows and
the panorama louvred sliding sunroof*
have closed.
The indicator lamp in the Ä button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
X
Convenience opening: press and hold the
Ä button until the side windows have
returned to the original position.
The indicator lamp in the Ä button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
The panorama louvred sliding sunroof*
moves to the ventilation position.
X
i Air-recirculation mode is activated automatically at high outside temperatures.
When air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically, the indicator lamp in the
Ä button is not lit.
Outside air is added after about 30
minutes.
23 Vehicles
Convenience opening/closing feature
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped between the side window and the door
frame as the side windows are opened and
closed. Do not place objects or lean against
the side windows when they are being
opened or closed. You or the objects could
be drawn in or become trapped between
the side window and the door frame as the
with air conditioning*/Thermotronic*.
* optional
141
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 142
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Roof
i If you open the side windows or the pan-
orama louvred sliding sunroof* manually
after closing with the convenience closing
feature, they will remain in this position
when opened using the convenience opening feature.
Switching the residual heat on/off
The "residual heat" function is only available
with Thermotronic*.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
of the engine to continue heating the stationary vehicle for up to 30 minutes after the
engine has been switched off. The heating
time depends on the set interior temperature.
i The blower will run at a low speed regardless of the airflow setting.
i If you activate the "residual heat" function
at high temperatures, only the ventilation
will be activated. The blower runs at
medium speed.
Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition
lock or remove it.
X To activate: press the T button.
The indicator lamp in the T button lights
up.
X
142
X
To deactivate: press the T button.
The indicator lamp in the T button goes
out.
i The residual heat automatically switches
off after around 30 minutes or if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe
battery voltage drops
Roof
Panorama roof*
G Risk of injury
The glass in the panorama sunroof* could
break in an accident.
If you are not wearing a seat belt, there is
a risk that you could be thrown through the
opening in the event of the vehicle overturning. Therefore, always wear a seat belt
to reduce the risk of injuries.
Panorama louvred sliding sunroof*
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped when closing the panorama louvred
sliding sunroof. If danger threatens, release
the switch and press the switch again to
reopen the panorama louvred sliding sunroof.
G Risk of injury
Never leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle. Always remove the key from the
ignition lock, even if you are leaving the
vehicle only briefly.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 143
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Roof
! Only open the panorama louvred sliding
sunroof if it is free of snow and ice. Otherwise, malfunctions may occur.
Do not allow anything to protrude from the
panorama louvred sliding sunroof. The
seals could otherwise be damaged.
i You can also set the panorama louvred
sliding sunroof to the ventilation position
from the outside by using the "Convenience
opening" feature (Y page 86).
The switch is in the overhead control panel.
Ventilation position
Opening and closing the cover*
To ventilate the vehicle, you can lift the rear
edge of the first pane on the panorama
louvred sliding sunroof.
X Press the switch in the direction of
arrow 1 and hold.
The panorama louvred sliding sunroof
stops in the ventilation position.
Opening
Press the switch in the direction of
arrow 1 and hold.
The panorama louvred sliding sunroof
stops in the ventilation position.
X Press the switch in the direction of
arrow 1 again and hold until the desired
position has been reached.
X
Cover 1 for the panorama louvred sliding
sunroof and the panorama roof shields the
vehicle interior from sunlight.
It is possible to open and close the cover by
hand regardless of the position of the panorama louvred sliding sunroof.
Closing
X
1 To open
2 To close
X
Press the switch in the direction of
arrow 2 and hold until the desired position
has been reached or the panorama louvred
sliding sunroof is closed.
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
* optional
Z
143
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 144
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Loading and stowing
Cup holder in the centre console
X
Cup holder
The stowage compartments in the doors contain mouldings designed to hold bottles.
holder is closed. Otherwise, the cup holder
could be damaged.
Keep the cup holder closed while the vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be injured by objects being
thrown around if you:
Rbrake sharply
Rare
direction suddenly
involved in an accident
Only use the cup holders for containers of
a suitable size and which have lids. Otherwise, the drinks could spill.
Cup holders should not be used for hot
drinks. Otherwise, you may scald yourself.
Roof rack system* and ski rack*
G Risk of accident
1 Cup holder
Cup holder in the rear compartment*
1 Cup holder
144
To open: fold down the rear seat armrest.
Press the front of cup holder 1.
The cup holder slides out automatically.
! Do not fold the armrest up unless the cup
G Risk of injury
Rchange
X
An incorrectly secured roof rack, ski rack
or load could work loose from the vehicle
and thereby cause an accident. Follow the
roof rack/ski rack manufacturers' installation instructions and special instructions
for use.
The roof load raises the vehicle's centre of
gravity, thereby affecting vehicle handling.
You must observe the maximum roof load
of 50 kg. Always adapt your driving style to
the prevailing road, traffic and weather conditions and drive with particular care if the
roof is laden.
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use roof rack systems which have
been tested and approved for Mercedes* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 145
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Benz vehicles. This helps to prevent damage to the vehicle.
Position the load on the roof rack in such a
way that the vehicle will not sustain damage even when it is in motion.
Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
make sure that you can:
Ropen the panorama louvred sliding sunroof* fully
Ropen
the tailgate fully
Observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions.
Luggage net
G Risk of injury
Only place lightweight items in the luggage
net. Do not use it to transport heavy, bulky,
sharp-edged or fragile objects. In the event
of an accident, the luggage net will not
secure the transported goods.
G Risk of poisoning
Keep the tailgate closed when the engine is
running. Otherwise, you could be poisoned
by exhaust fumes entering the vehicle.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle depend on the distribution of the load
within the vehicle. You should therefore load
your vehicle as shown in the illustrations.
Loading guidelines
G Risk of injury
1 Covers
Fold covers 1 upwards.
X Only secure the roof rack to the anchorage
points under covers 1.
X
Secure and position the load as described
in the loading guidelines.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could
be injured by the load being thrown around
in the event of sharp braking, a sudden
change in direction or an accident. This also
applies to seats which have been removed.
You will find further information in the
"Securing a load" section.
Even if you follow all the loading guidelines,
the load will increase the risk of injury in the
event of an accident.
Observe the following notes when transporting a load:
RWhen transporting a load, never exceed the
maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
or the permissible axle loads for the vehicle
(including occupants).
RPosition heavy loads as far forwards and as
low down in the luggage compartment as
possible.
RThe
load must not protrude above the
upper edge of the backrests.
Z
145
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 146
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
RAlways place the load against the rear seat
compartment floor will be increased when
the load is lashed down.
backrests or the seat cushions if these
have been folded forwards.
RThe maximum load capacity of the stowage
Securing a load
well under the luggage compartment floor
is 25 kg.
Lashing eyelets
RAlways
place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
RSecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant load restraints. Pad sharp
edges for protection.
i Load restraints are available at any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
RIf the rear seats are not occupied, insert the
belt tongue on the outer seat belts into the
buckle of the opposite seat belt. This
increases the restraining effect of the rear
seat backrests.
! Do not position the load on one part of the
folding luggage compartment floor only.
The maximum load capacity of the folding
luggage compartment floor is 100 kg.
Spread the weight evenly to avoid damaging the luggage compartment floor. If necessary, place a solid board under the load.
Please note that the load on the luggage
146
G Risk of injury
Distribute the load on the lashing eyelets
evenly.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if
you:
Rbrake sharply
Rchange direction suddenly
Rare involved in an accident
Please observe the loading guidelines.
Observe the following points or guidelines
when securing loads:
RSecure the load using the lashing eyelets.
RDo
not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
RDo not route lashing materials across sharp
edges or corners.
RPad
sharp edges for protection.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 147
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Securing loads in the luggage compartment
There are four lashing eyelets in the luggage
compartment.
Securing a load when the seats have been
removed
RThe
load must not protrude above the
upper edge of the door trim.
RLong
loads must only be placed low down
and towards the front of the frontpassenger footwell.
! Load restraints must not be fastened to
Rear seat removed
Guide the load restraints in a cross pattern
over the load, as shown in the illustration.
X Secure the load using the lashing eyelets
or the mounting cups on the seats.
X
Example: 5-door vehicle
1 Lashing eyelets
X
Secure the load using lashing eyelets 1 or
the mounting cups for the seats, if the seats
have been removed.
G Risk of injury
Always stow the load so that it does not
interfere with driving the vehicle.
Avoid obstructing the driver's line-of-sight.
The load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the door trim if the front-passenger
seat has been removed.
Pad sharp edges for protection. This will
reduce the risk of lacerations and prevent
the load restraints from wearing.
Observe the following notes:
the front right-hand mounting cup. Otherwise, the contact switch for the frontpassenger seat could be damaged.
Securing a light load using a retaining
net*
X Place the retaining net over the load.
X Engage the retaining net hooks in the lashing eyelets.
Through-loading feature*
G Risk of injury
Do not transport unsecured objects in the
through-loading facility.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants could be injured by objects being
thrown around the vehicle in the event of
sharp braking, a sudden change in direction
or an accident.
Z
* optional
147
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 148
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Removing the armrest
To enable you to use the maximum throughloading opening and to prevent the armrest
from becoming dirty or being damaged, the
armrest should be removed (Y page 148).
Opening the through-loading facility
2 Cover in the luggage compartment
3 Locking mechanism
Slide locking mechanism 3 in the direction of the arrow.
X Swing cover 2 to the side.
Cover 2 is held open by a magnet.
X
1 Armrest
X
Fold down armrest 1.
1 Armrest
X
Fold down armrest 1.
Closing the through-loading facility
Swing back cover 2 in the luggage compartment until it engages.
X Fold the armrest up fully if necessary.
X
2 Release
148
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 149
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Pull release 2 upwards and hold it
securely.
X Pull armrest 1 out towards the front.
Hold the side of armrest 1 as you do this,
otherwise you could inadvertently open the
cup holder.
X
i The release remains in the open position
after armrest 1 has been removed.
! Do not press the release down when the
armrest has been removed, otherwise the
armrest mechanism could be damaged.
Fitting the armrest
X
X
Align the armrest.
Slide the armrest back until it engages.
The release drops down. Make sure that the
red area 1 of the release is no longer visible. If it is still visible, the armrest is not
locked in position.
G Risk of injury
The armrests must be locked in position
when the vehicle is being driven.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could
be injured by the armrest being thrown
around in the event of sharp braking, a sudden change in direction or an accident.
Nobody should travel in the vehicle sitting
in the centre position in the rear compartment if the armrest has been removed.
EASY-VARIO system*
On 3-door vehicle variants, the "Variable luggage compartment floor" (Y page 155) and
"Removing the rear seat cushion"
(Y page 151) functions are combined in the
EASY-VARIO system.
EASY-VARIO-PLUS system*
On 5-door vehicle variants, the "Removing the
rear seat cushion" (Y page 151), "Removing
the backrest" (Y page 152), "Removable
front-passenger seat" (Y page 156) and
"Folding backrest on the front-passenger
seat" (Y page 158) functions are combined
in the EASY-VARIO-PLUS system.
! Do not close the armrest unless it has
been locked in position, otherwise the armrest mechanism could be damaged.
1 Red area
Z
* optional
149
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 150
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Enlarging the luggage compartment
Folding the rear bench seat forwards
The left-hand and right-hand rear seats can
be folded down to increase the luggage compartment capacity.
G Risk of injury
Pull seat cushion release handle 1.
The seat cushion is unlocked.
X Fold the right-hand or left-hand seat cushion forward.
X
5-door vehicles
Make sure that nobody can become trapped as you fold the backrests forward.
! To prevent damage, before the backrests
are folded forward:
Rthe head restraints must be pushed in
fully
1 Belt retainer
Rthe
X
front seats must be as far forwards
as possible
Rthe seat cushions must be folded forward
Insert the seat belt into belt retainer 1.
3-door vehicles
1 Seat cushion
or removed
X
1 Seat cushion release handle
150
Fold left or right seat cushion 1 forwards.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 151
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
3 and 5-door vehicles
Swinging back the rear bench seat
G Risk of injury
Make sure that the backrest is correctly
locked in position. The red lock verification
indicators on the left and right sides should
no longer be visible. If they are visible, the
backrests are not locked in position.
Occupants could then be injured in the
event of an accident, e.g. by objects being
thrown forwards from the luggage compartment.
2 Backrest release handle
3 Backrest
Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle
2 on backrest.
Corresponding backrest 3 is unlocked.
X Fold the backrest forwards until it rests on
the hinge fixtures (Y page 152).
X Move the front seats to the desired positions.
4 Red lock verification indicator
X
X
Removing rear seat cushions*
Swing the backrest back until it engages.
Red lock verification indicator 4 is no longer visible.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped.
Swing the seat cushion backwards.
Adjust the head restraints if necessary .
X Move the front seats to the desired positions.
If red lock verification indicator 4 is visible,
this means the backrest is not engaged.
X
X
1 Belt retainer
X
Insert the seat belt into belt retainer 1.
Z
151
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 152
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Grasp release handle 2 and pull seat cushion 3 upwards.
X Remove seat cushion 3.
X
! Vehicles with emergency spare wheel*,
loud speaker system* or sound system*:
You cannot stow any seat cushions under
the variable luggage compartment floor*.
Fitting rear seat cushions*
Fold hinge 4 upwards if necessary. Only
then can the seat cushion be slid in.
X Slide the seat cushion onto the fixtures
until it engages.
X
1 Seat cushion
X
i For easier alignment of the cushions,
Fold left or right seat cushion 1 forwards.
4 Hinge
X
If the backrest is to be removed: fold down
hinge 4.
If the backrest is only to be folded down:
leave hinge 4 as a support for the backrest
in the position shown above.
i Vehicles with TIREFIT kit:
2 Release handle
3 Seat cushion
152
You can stow the seat cushions under the
variable luggage compartment floor*.
Vehicles with emergency spare wheel:
You can stow a seat cushion under the variable luggage compartment floor*.
observe the arrows on the rear of the seat
cushions.
X
Swing the seat cushion back.
Removing the backrests*
X
Fold the seat cushion forwards
(Y page 151).
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 153
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
X
Press seat belt buckle 1 on the grooved
surface and remove seat belt buckle 1
from holder 3.
i When the ignition is switched on an indi-
1 Connector
2 Connector holder
3 Lever
Warning symbol on the connector of the rear seat
belt status indicator
cator is shows the status of the corresponding rear seats in the upper multifunction display. If, for example, neither
seat belt buckle are is engaged, the message: < No rear seat belt
engaged appears.
Stow seat belt buckle 1 on seat belt
buckle holder 2 on the vehicle floor.
X Pull holder 3 upwards and hold it securely.
X
4 Backrest release handle
5 Backrest
Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle
4 on backrest 5.
Corresponding backrest 5 is unlocked.
X Fold backrest 5 forwards past the vertical
to an angle of approximately 20°.
X Hold backrest 5 with your free hand and
lift the backrest by pulling lever 3.
X
i For greater convenience, there is a recess
on the rear of the 2/3 backrest which
makes it easier to grasp the backrest.
X Remove backrest 5 from the vehicle
through the rear door.
Fitting the backrest*
1 Recesses
Z
153
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 154
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
X
Place the backrest, starting with the front
seat feet, onto the locking bolts in recesses
1.
Fit the seat cushions as required.
Swing the seat cushion backwards.
X Adjust the head restraints if necessary .
If red lock verification indicator 2 is visible,
this means the backrest is not engaged.
X
X
G Risk of injury
2 Red lock verification indicator
Swing the backrest back until it engages.
Red lock verification indicator 2 is no longer visible.
X Make sure that the lever is lying flat on the
vehicle floor.
X Take the connector out of the recesses on
the vehicle floor.
X Insert the connector back into the lever
until you hear it engage.
X
i Make sure that you insert the connector
correctly into the lever, as the rear seat belt
status will otherwise no longer be displayed
in the instrument cluster.
154
Make sure that the backrest is correctly
locked in position. The red lock verification
indicators on the left and right sides should
no longer be visible. If they are visible, the
backrests are not locked in position.
Occupants could then be injured in the
event of an accident, e.g. by objects being
thrown forwards from the luggage compartment.
X
Fold back the seat cushion.
Stowage well under the luggage compartment floor
The maximum load capacity of the stowage
well under the luggage compartment floor is
25 kg.
G Risk of injury
You should always close the luggage compartment floor if you are transporting
objects in the stowage well under the luggage compartment floor.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants could be injured by objects being
thrown around the vehicle in the event of
sharp braking, a sudden change in direction
or an accident.
Removing/fitting the luggage compartment floor (3-door vehicles without variable luggage compartment floor)
You can remove the luggage compartment
floor to enable you to load and unload the
stowage well more easily.
X To remove: raise the luggage compartment floor to an angle of approximately
45°.
X Remove the luggage compartment floor.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 155
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
To fit: insert the luggage compartment
floor into the guide rail at an angle of
approximately 45°.
X Fold the luggage compartment floor down.
X
sharp braking, a sudden change in direction
or an accident.
Adjusting the height of the luggage
compartment floor*
Opening/closing the luggage compartment floor (vehicles with variable luggage compartment floor)
Opening the luggage compartment floor
3 Bag hook
Press bag hook 3 (Y page 158).
Bag hook 3 slides out.
X Place luggage compartment floor 2 onto
bag hook 3.
X
1 Handle
2 Luggage compartment floor
X
Pull handle 1 until it is vertical and then
swing luggage compartment floor 2
upwards.
The stowage well under the luggage compartment floor can be increased or decreased in
size as necessary. To do this, you can lock the
floor at two different heights. The upper catch
gives a flat load surface when the rear bench
seat is folded forward.
Raising the luggage compartment floor
Closing the luggage compartment floor
X Press in bag hook 3 until it engages.
X Swing the luggage compartment floor
downwards.
G Risk of injury
The luggage compartment floor must
be locked correctly when items are carried
in it.
Otherwise, you and other vehicle occupants could be injured by objects being
thrown around the vehicle in the event of
1 Handle
2 Luggage compartment floor
3 To raise
Z
155
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 156
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Raise luggage compartment floor 2 using
handle 1 in the direction of the arrow 3
and tug it upwards sharply.
X Lower luggage compartment floor 2
again. To do this, push the luggage compartment floor away so that it engages in
the guide on the upper level.
Luggage compartment floor 2 engages in
the higher position.
X
Lowering the luggage compartment floor
X Raise luggage compartment floor 2
slightly using handle 1 and tug it briefly
towards you.
X Lower luggage compartment floor 2 again
slowly. To do this, press the luggage compartment floor into the lower level.
Luggage compartment floor 2 engages in
the lower position.
Removing/fitting the removable
front-passenger seat*
Removing the front-passenger seat
! To avoid damage, the head restraint must
be pushed in fully before the frontpassenger seat is removed.
Move the front-passenger seat to its rearmost position.
X Disconnect connector 1.
A signal sounds. The lock for lever 2 is
released. If the engine is running, the
5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning
lamp flashes and the 1 warning lamp
lights up after a short time.
X Move the front-passenger seat to its centre
position.
It is only possible to remove the seat without tilting it when it is in this position
X Store connector 1 under the seat in such
a way that the cable does not get caught
on the seat frame.
X
1 Connector
2 Lever
! Do not operate the lever until you have
pulled out the connector. The use of force
when opening will cause damage to
mechanical and electronic components.
156
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 157
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Open cable box 3 and place connector
1 inside.
X Close cable box 3.
X
G Risk of injury
The front-passenger seat which has been
removed contains an active sidebag. Do not
attach a power source to the connector on
the seat, otherwise the airbag could inflate.
Store the seat out of the reach of children.
Fitting the front-passenger seat
1 Connector
2 Lever
3 Cable box
Swing lever 2 forwards and pull upwards.
The seat slides out of the front mounting
cups.
X Take hold of the seat at the back of the
backrest and at the front edge of the seat
cushion.
X Guide the seat through the front-passenger
door opening.
X
G Risk of injury
The mounting cups must be free from dirt
and other items in order for the frontpassenger seat to engage securely.
You must connect up the connector, so that
the front-passenger airbag can deploy in
the event of an accident.
If it is not connected and the engine is running, the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
warning lamp flashes and the 1 warning
lamp lights up after a short time.
1 Rear mounting cups
2 Front mounting cups
3 Connector
4 Cable box
5 Lever
6 Seat frame
Take connector 3 out of cable box 4 and
place it at the front.
X Take hold of the seat at the back of the
backrest and at the front edge of the seat
cushion.
X
157
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 158
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Guide the seat through the front-passenger
door opening.
X Move the seat into position over the mounting cups.
X Insert the seat hook into rear mounting
cups 1.
X Push the front of the seat down until it
engages.
Lever 5 springs back to its starting position. Only then is the seat correctly locked
in position.
X Route connector 3 over seat frame 6.
X Insert connector 3 into the coupling on
the seat.
X
G Risk of injury
Before starting off, make sure that the seat
has engaged properly.
Folding backrest on the frontpassenger seat*
Folding the front-passenger seat backrest forward
Folding back the front-passenger seat
backrest
Push the backrest down slightly and pull
release handle 1.
X Swing the backrest back until it engages.
X
Bag hook
There is a bag hook in the luggage compartment on the left-hand side.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load
of 5 kg. Do not use it to secure a load.
1 Release handle
X
X
Push the backrest back slightly.
Pull the release handle 1 and swing the
backrest fully onto the seat cushion until it
engages.
1 Bag hook
X
158
To open: press bag hook 1 (arrow).
Bag hook 1 slides out.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 159
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
X
To close: press bag hook 1 until it
engages.
Rolling up the luggage compartment
cover
X
Luggage compartment cover*
Unclip luggage compartment cover 1 and
guide it forwards.
i You can fold up the part of the luggage
compartment cover which remains visible.
Removing the luggage compartment
cover
Make sure that luggage compartment
cover 1 is rolled up.
X Press the handle on the right underside in
the direction of the arrow 2.
X Remove luggage compartment cover 1.
X
Fitting the luggage compartment cover
Align luggage compartment cover 1 in the
hole on the left-hand side when viewed in
the direction of travel.
X Press the handle in the opposite direction
to the arrow.
X Allow luggage compartment cover 1 to
engage in the appropriate recess.
X
1 Luggage compartment cover
Stowage compartments
Pulling out the luggage compartment
cover
X
Pull luggage compartment cover 1 back
and clip it into the retainers on the left and
right-hand sides.
G Risk of injury
1 Luggage compartment cover
2 To release
The stowage compartments must be closed
when items are stored in them. Luggage
nets are not designed to secure heavy
items of luggage.
You or other vehicle occupants could be
injured by objects being thrown around if
you:
Z
* optional
159
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 160
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
Rbrake
sharply
Rchange
Rare
direction suddenly
involved in an accident
Sharp-edged and fragile objects must not
be placed in the luggage net.
Glove compartment
i In the glove compartment there are stowage spaces for the following:
Rcoins
Rpens
Rcredit
cards and service cards
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
you will find installed in the glove compartment either a CD holder*, an AUX-IN connection* or a Media Interface*, which is a
universal interface for portable audio
equipment, e.g. for an iPod or USB device.
i Glove compartment ventilation*:
the glove compartment is ventilated by an
adjustable vent (Y page 137).
1 Handle
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there is a CD changer* in the glove compartment.
To open: pull handle 1 and open the glove
compartment lid.
X To close: push the glove compartment lid
up firmly until it engages.
1 Cover
X
To open: slide cover 1 forwards.
Stowage compartment/telephone
compartment* in front of the armrest
Stowage compartment in the front
centre console
If your vehicle is not equipped with the smoker's package*, a 12 V power socket is fitted
in place of the ashtray.
X
160
1 Stowage compartment
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 161
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Loading and stowing
X
To open: briefly press the cover of stowage
compartment 1.
Stowage compartment 1 opens.
X
Stowage compartment in the rear compartment
i Several CD jewel cases 2 can be stacked
in the stowage box. There is a catch 1 fitted to stop the CD cases moving around.
Stowage boxes* under the driver's seat
and front-passenger seat
The stowage boxes can store up to 2.5 kg.
To open: raise the stowage box slightly and
pull it out using handle 3.
Stowage compartment under the armrest*
1 Stowage compartment
X
The illustration shows the driver's seat
1 Stop for CD jewel case
2 CD jewel case
3 Recess
1 Stowage compartment
G Risk of injury
There is the risk of entrapment when sliding
the armrest forwards or backwards.
X
To open: slide the armrest forwards.
To open: pull out the top of stowage compartment 1 by the edge of the handle.
Stowage compartments in the luggage
compartment
G Risk of injury
The stowage boxes can store up to 1.5 kg.
The objects in the left-hand stowage compartment should only be placed in the designated spaces and secured using the
appropriate holders. Otherwise, the stowage compartment could open and you and
other vehicle occupants could be injured by
161
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 162
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Features
objects being thrown around the vehicle
interior in the event of sharp braking, a sudden change in direction or an accident.
The stowage compartments are located in the
luggage compartment on the left and righthand sides.
Features
Mirror in the sun visor
Sun visors
Mirror light* 1 only comes on if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer 2 and mirror cover
5 has been folded up.
G Risk of accident
Keep the mirrors in the sun visors covered
while driving. Otherwise, you could be dazzled, impairing your view of traffic conditions. As a result, you could cause an accident.
Glare from the side
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor from retainer 2.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X
X
Ashtray*
Ashtray in the cockpit
1 Handle
i The left-hand stowage compartment con-
tains the first-aid kit, the vehicle tool kit, the
jack, the warning triangle and TIREFIT.
To open: turn handle 1 away from the
direction of travel.
X Fold down the flap.
X
162
1 Mirror light*
2 Retainer
3 Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
4 Vanity mirror
5 Mirror cover
1 Cover
2 Ashtray
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 163
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Features
To open: slide cover 1 forwards.
Ashtray 2 opens.
X To remove the insert: pull the insert up
and out.
X To refit the insert: press the insert into the
holder until it clicks into place.
X
Ashtray in the rear compartment
Cigarette lighter*
G Risk of injury and fire
Only hold the hot cigarette lighter by its
knob. Otherwise, you might burn yourself.
Make sure that children travelling in the
vehicle are not able to injure themselves on
the hot cigarette lighter or cause a fire with
it.
Make sure that the key is in position 2 in
the ignition lock.
X Slide cover 1 forwards.
X Press in cigarette lighter 2.
Cigarette lighter 2 will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
12 V socket
The socket can be used for accessories with
a maximum power consumption of 180 watts.
Socket in the cockpit
A socket is fitted in the centre console on
vehicles with the non-smoker's package.
1 Ashtray
To open: pull ashtray 1 out by its top
edge.
X To remove the insert: pull the insert up
and out beyond the stop.
X To refit the insert: press the insert into the
holder until it clicks into place.
X
* optional
1 Cover
2 Cigarette lighter
1 Socket
Z
163
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 164
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Features
X
Lift up the cover of socket 1.
Socket in the luggage compartment*
The socket is located in the left-hand stowage
compartment in the luggage compartment.
1 Socket
Open the stowage compartment
(Y page 161).
X Lift up the cover of socket 1.
X
Mobile phone*
G Risk of accident
Observe the legal requirements of the
country in which you are currently driving
regarding operating mobile communications equipment in a vehicle.
If it is permitted by law to operate communications equipment while the vehicle is in
motion, you may only do so when the traffic
situation allows. Otherwise, you could be
distracted from the traffic conditions,
cause an accident and injure yourself and
others.
Two-way radios and fax equipment used
without low-reflection exterior aerials can
interfere with the vehicle's electronics and,
thereby, jeopardise the operating safety of
the vehicle and your safety. Therefore, you
may only use this equipment if it is correctly
connected to a separate reflection-free
exterior aerial.
G Risk of injury
Excessive electromagnetic radiation may
cause damage to your health and the health
of others. Using an exterior aerial takes into
account current scientific discussions
164
relating to the possible health risk posed by
electromagnetic fields.
To ensure optimum reception quality for
mobile phones in the vehicle, and to minimise
mutual influences between the vehicle electronics and mobile phones, Mercedes-Benz
recommends the use of an approved exterior
aerial. An exterior aerial conducts the electromagnetic fields generated by a wireless
device to the exterior of the vehicle; the field
strength within the vehicle interior is lower
than in a vehicle that does not have an exterior aerial.
i There are various mobile phone brackets
that may be fitted to your vehicle; in some
cases, these are country-specific. You can
obtain these mobile phone brackets from a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The functions and services available when
you use the phone depend on your mobile
phone model and service provider.
Inserting the mobile phone
Open the telephone compartment
(Y page 160).
X Place the mobile phone bracket into the
pre-installed fitting; see the separate
X
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 165
Version: 2.10.6
Controls
Features
mobile phone bracket installation instructions.
X Insert the mobile phone into the mobile
phone bracket; see the separate mobile
phone bracket installation instructions.
If the mobile phone is inserted in the mobile
phone bracket, you can speak to the person
you are calling using the hands-free system.
You can operate the telephone using the
s and t buttons on the multi-function
steering wheel. You can operate other mobile
phone functions via the on-board computer
(Y page 113).
When you take the key out of the ignition lock,
the mobile phone stays on but you can no
longer use the hands-free system.
If you are making a call and you would like to
take the key out of the ignition lock, first
remove the mobile phone from the bracket.
Otherwise, the call will be terminated.
Floormat on the driver's side
G Risk of accident
Make sure that there is sufficient clearance
around the pedals when floormats are
used, and that the floormats are properly
secured.
The floormats must be secured at all times
using retainers and studs.
Before you drive off, make sure that the
floormats are secure and rectify if necessary. A floormat which is not properly
secured can slip and thereby interfere with
the movement of the pedals.
Do not place floormats on top of one
another.
1 Press-studs
2 Retainers
Slide seat backwards.
To fit: place the floormat in position.
X Press stud 1 onto retainer 2.
X
X
X
X
To remove: pull floormat off retainers 2.
Remove the floormat.
Z
165
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
166
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 166
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 167
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Running-in notes ...............................
Refuelling ...........................................
Engine compartment ........................
Tyres and wheels ..............................
Winter driving ...................................
Driving tips ........................................
Driving abroad ...................................
168
168
171
176
181
183
185
Trailer towing* .................................. 186
Service ............................................... 191
Care .................................................... 192
167
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 168
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Refuelling
Running-in notes
Refuelling
The first 1,500 km
Refuelling
If you treat the engine with sufficient care
from the very start, you will be rewarded with
excellent performance for the remainder of
the engine's life.
RYou should therefore drive at varying road
and engine speeds for the first 1,500 km.
RAvoid
heavy loads, e.g. driving at full throttle, during this time. Do not exceed 2/3 of
the maximum permissible engine speed for
each gear.
RChange
gear in good time.
RDo
not shift down a gear manually in order
to brake.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*:
RTry to avoid depressing the accelerator
pedal beyond the pressure point (kickdown).
ROnly
use ranges 3, 2 or 1 for slow driving,
e.g. in mountainous terrain.
After 1,500 km you may gradually bring the
vehicle up to full road and engine speeds.
168
G Risk of explosion
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Before refuelling, always turn off the
engine.
G Risk of injury
Avoid any contact with fuels.
You can damage your health if your skin
comes into direct contact with fuel or if you
inhale fuel vapours.
G Risk of fire
Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Never mix diesel with petrol.
This causes damage to the fuel system and
engine and could result in the vehicle catching fire.
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Even small
amounts of the wrong fuel will cause damage to the injection system. Damage result-
ing from adding the wrong fuel is not covered by the warranty.
! Do not start the engine if you accidentally
refuel with the wrong fuel. Otherwise, the
fuel could enter the fuel lines. This would
require draining of the fuel tank and fuel
lines. Notify a qualified specialist workshop
and have the fuel tank and fuel lines
drained completely.
When you open or close the vehicle with the
key, the fuel filler flap is automatically
unlocked or locked.
The position of the fuel filler cap is to the rear
on the right. The fuel tank filler flap is shown
in the instrument cluster 4. The arrow on
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 169
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Refuelling
the filling pump indicates the side of the vehicle.
To close: replace the fuel filler cap and turn
it clockwise. The fuel filler cap audibly
engages.
X Close the fuel filler flap.
X
i Vehicles with a diesel engine:
if the fuel tank has been run completely dry,
it will be necessary to bleed the fuel system
(Y page 232).
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, the petrol
may be mixed with the additive recommended by Mercedes-Benz (part no.
A000989254510). You must observe the
notes and mixing ratios specified on the
container.
For further information on "Fuel" see
(Y page 292).
Turbo engines
Petrol (EN 228)
1 To open the fuel filler flap
2 To insert the fuel cap
3 Tyre pressure table
4 Fuel type
To open: press the fuel filler flap in the
direction of arrow 1.
X Turn the fuel filler cap to the left and
remove it.
X Insert the fuel filler cap into the holder
bracket on the inside of filler flap 2.
X Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
X
! Overfilling the fuel tank could damage the
fuel system.
! Refuel using only unleaded premium
grade petrol with a minimum octane number of 95 RON/85 MON conforming to
European standard EN 228.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the engine.
i As a temporary measure, only when the
recommended fuel is not available, you
may also use regular unleaded petrol,
91 RON/82.5 MON. This may reduce
engine performance and increase fuel consumption. Avoid driving at full throttle.
In some countries, the available petrol quality may not be adequate and could cause
coking around the inlet valve. In such
cases, and in consultation with a
! Refuel using only unleaded Super Plus
with a minimum octane number of
98 RON/88 MON conforming to European
standard EN 228.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the engine.
i If the recommended fuel is not available
and only as a temporary measure, you may
also use premium unleaded petrol,
95 RON/85 MON. This may reduce engine
performance and increase fuel consumption. You must avoid driving at full throttle.
Z
169
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 170
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Refuelling
Diesel (EN 590)
! Only use diesel that complies with the
EN 590 European standard.
You could otherwise impair engine output
or damage the engine.
You will find further information about diesel under "Fuel" in the index.
! When refuelling vehicles with a diesel par-
ticle filter in countries outside the EU, only
low-sulphur Euro diesel with less than
0.005 percent sulphur content by weight
should be used. In countries in which diesel
with a higher sulphur content is available
(e.g. 0.035 percent by weight), the engine
oil should be renewed at more frequent
intervals. More information about intervals
for changing the engine oil can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Using fuel that does not comply with
EN 590 can increase wear and damage the
engine and the exhaust system.
Do not use the following:
Rmarine
diesel
Rheating
oil
Rbio-diesel
170
Rvegetable
oil
Rpetrol
Rparaffin
Rkerosene
Do not add such fuels to diesel fuel and do
not use any special additives (exception:
flow improvers – see "Low outside temperatures").
Damage caused by the use of unapproved
fuels or additives is not covered by the warranty.
For further information on "Fuel" see
(Y page 292).
Low outside temperatures
The flow properties of diesel may be inadequate at low ambient temperatures.
To prevent operating problems, diesel fuel
with improved cold flow qualities is available
during the winter months. Your vehicle must
be refuelled with this winter diesel at temperatures of -5 °C or below.
You can use this winter diesel at temperatures down to about -20 °C without problems.
If only summer diesel fuel or less cold-resistant winter diesel fuel (e.g. in Mediterranean
regions) is available, you should add an
amount of flow improver to the fuel corresponding to the outside temperature.
Mix the additive with the diesel in good time,
before the flow properties of the diesel
become inadequate. Otherwise, malfunctions
can only be rectified by heating the entire fuel
system, e.g. by parking the vehicle in a heated
garage.
G Risk of fire
Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Never mix diesel with petrol.
This would damage the fuel system and
engine and could result in a vehicle fire.
Flow improver
The effectiveness of a flow improver is not
guaranteed with every fuel. Observe the information provided by the manufacturer when
using a flow improver. Only use flow improvers that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz. Information about flow
improvers that have been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 171
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Engine compartment
Engine compartment
Bonnet
G Risk of accident
Do not pull the release lever while the vehicle is in motion. The bonnet may otherwise
open and block your view.
Opening
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of injury if the bonnet is open,
even if the engine is not running.
Some engine components can become
very hot.
To avoid the risk of burns, only touch those
components described in the Operating
Instructions and observe the relevant
safety notes.
G Risk of injury
The radiator fan between the radiator and
the engine can start automatically, even if
the key has been removed from the ignition
lock. For this reason you must not reach
into the turning area of the fan. You can
otherwise be injured.
Vehicles with a petrol engine:
The electronic ignition system uses high
voltage. For this reason, you must never
touch components of the ignition system
(ignition coil, ignition cable, spark plug connector or test socket) when:
Rthe
engine is running
Rthe
engine is being started
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off and that the key has been
pulled out of the ignition lock before opening the bonnet.
The bonnet release lever is located in the
driver's footwell.
Rthe ignition is switched on and the engine
is being cranked by hand
Vehicles with a diesel engine:
The electronic injection control uses high
voltage. Therefore, never touch fuel injection system components when:
Rthe
engine is running
Rthe
engine is being started
Rthe
ignition is switched on
X
Make sure that the windscreen wipers are
switched off.
G Risk of injury
The windscreen wipers and wiper linkage
could be set in motion.
When the bonnet is open, you or others
could be injured by the wiper rods.
1 Bonnet release lever
X
Pull bonnet release lever 1.
The bonnet is released.
! Make sure that the windscreen wipers
are not folded out from the windscreen.
You could otherwise damage the windscreen wipers or the bonnet.
Z
171
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 172
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Engine compartment
The handle for opening the bonnet is located
above the radiator grille.
Lower the bonnet and let it fall from a
height of approximately 20 cm.
X Check that the bonnet has engaged properly.
X
i If the bonnet can be raised slightly, it is
not properly engaged. Open it again and
close it with a little more force.
Engine oil
3 Recess
4 Support strut
2 Bonnet catch handle
X
Pull handle 2 of the bonnet catch outwards from the radiator grille and lift the
bonnet from underneath by the radiator
grille.
5 Bracket
X
X
Pull support strut 4 out of bracket 5.
Swing support strut 4 upwards and insert
it into yellow recess 3.
Closing
G Risk of injury
Make sure that nobody can become trapped as you close the bonnet.
Raise the bonnet slightly and remove support strut 4 from yellow recess 3.
X Swing support strut 4 down and press it
into bracket 5 until it engages.
X
172
Depending on driving style, the vehicle consumes a maximum of 0.8 l oil per 1,000 km.
The oil consumption may be higher than this
when the vehicle is new or if you frequently
drive at high engine speeds. You can only
estimate the oil consumption after you have
driven a considerable distance.
For further information on engine oil see
(Y page 296).
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 173
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Engine compartment
Checking the engine oil level
Eng. oil level
Reduce oil level
X Have excess oil siphoned off.
To do so:
Rthe
vehicle should be parked on level
ground
! There is a risk of damage to the engine or
the catalytic converter if there is excess oil
in the engine.
Rthe
engine should be switched off for at
least five minutes if the engine was at normal operating temperature.
Rthe
engine should be switched off for at
least 30 minutes if the engine was not at
operating temperature (i.e. if you only started the engine briefly)
Using the on-board computer*
i Only possible on vehicles with a diesel
engine. A dipstick is used to check petrol
engines (Y page 174).
Make sure that the key is in position
2 (Y page 62) in the ignition lock.
X Press the j or k button to select the
following message:
X
The measurement takes a few seconds. You
will see one of the following messages in the
display:
REngine oil level OK
RAdd
1.0 litre to reach maximum oil
level
RAdd
1.5 litres to reach maximum oil
level
RAdd
2.0 litres to reach maximum oil
level
X
Top up the oil if necessary (Y page 174).
Other messages in the multi-function display
If the engine is at normal operating temperature and there is too much oil, you will see the
following message:
* optional
If the Switch ignition on to check
engine oil level message appears:
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
You will see the following message if you did
not observe the required waiting period:
Observe waiting period
X Repeat the measurement after about five
minutes if the engine is at normal operating
temperature.
X Repeat the measurement after about
30 minutes if the engine is not at normal
operating temperature (if the engine was
only started briefly).
The following message appears if the engine
is running:
Engine oil level Not when engine on
X Switch off the engine and wait for five
minutes if the engine is at normal operating
temperature, or for about 30 minutes if the
engine is not at normal operating temper-
173
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 174
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Engine compartment
Topping up the engine oil
ature (if the engine was only started
briefly), before measuring.
i If you wish to cancel the measurement,
press the k or j button on the multifunction steering wheel.
Using the oil dipstick
Example: vehicles with a turbo/diesel engine
1 Oil dipstick
2 Maximum mark
3 Minimum mark
Pull oil dipstick 1 out of the oil dipstick
tube.
X Wipe off oil dipstick 1.
X Insert oil dipstick 1 into the oil dipstick
tube to the stop, and take it out again.
The oil level is correct if the level is between
minimum mark 3 and maximum mark
2.
X Top up the oil if necessary.
X
Example: vehicles with a petrol engine
1 Oil dipstick
2 Maximum mark
3 Minimum mark
Example: vehicles with a petrol/diesel engine
1 Cap
X
X
i The difference in quantity between the
minimum mark and the maximum mark is
approximately 1.2 litres. On the A 160 CDI
it is approximately 1.5 litres.
! Do not add too much oil. If too much oil
is added (oil level is above the maximum
mark on the dipstick) the engine or catalytic converter could be damaged. Have
excess oil siphoned off.
X
174
Unscrew cap 1 and remove it.
Top up with the required amount of oil
(Y page 296).
Screw cap 1 onto the filler neck.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 175
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Engine compartment
H Environmental note
Checking the coolant level
X
When topping up the oil, take care not to
spill any. Oil must not be allowed to escape
into the soil or waterways. You would otherwise be damaging the environment.
The coolant expansion tank is located in the
engine compartment on the right when
viewed in the direction of travel.
X
For further information on engine oil
(Y page 296).
Windscreen washer system/headlamp cleaning system*
Coolant
The washer fluid reservoir is located in the
engine compartment on the left-hand side of
the vehicle when viewed in the direction of
travel. The headlamp cleaning system is also
supplied from the washer fluid reservoir.
G Risk of injury
The cooling system is pressurised. Therefore, only unscrew the cap once the engine
has cooled down. The coolant temperature
gauge must display less than 70 °C. You
could otherwise be scalded by escaping hot
coolant.
Coolant consists of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Only check the coolant level
when the vehicle is on a level surface and the
engine has cooled down.
* optional
Top up the coolant if necessary.
Replace cap 1 and tighten all the way to
the stop.
For further information on coolant see
(Y page 297) .
1 Cap
2 Coolant expansion tank
3 Marker bar
Slowly turn cap 1 half a turn anti-clockwise to allow excess pressure to escape.
X Turn cap 1 further anti-clockwise and
remove it.
There is sufficient coolant in expansion
tank 2 if the coolant is level with marker
bar 3 in the filler neck when cold or
approximately 1.5 cm higher when hot.
X
1 Cap
X
Add windscreen washer concentrate to the
washer fluid all year round.
175
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 176
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Tyres and wheels
G Risk of fire
Tyres and wheels
Windscreen washer fluid is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling washer fluid concentrate.
Points to remember
At temperatures above freezing:
fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mix of
water and windscreen washer concentrate
(Y page 175).
X At temperatures below freezing:
fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mix of
water, antifreeze additive and windscreen
washer concentrate (Y page 175). Adapt
the mixing ratio to the outside temperatures.
X
X
Mix the windscreen washer fluid in a container beforehand.
! Only use windscreen washer fluid which
is suitable for plastic lamp lenses. Unsuitable windscreen washer fluid could damage the plastic lamp lenses of the headlamps.
To open: pull cap 1 upwards by the tab.
X To close: press cap 1 onto the filler neck
until it clicks into place.
X
176
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle. These tyres have been specially adapted for use with the control systems, such
as ABS or ESP®, and are marked as follows:
RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(with run-flat characteristics)*
*Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tyres
should only be used on wheels that have
been specifically approved by MercedesBenz.
If you use other tyres and wheels,
Mercedes-Benz cannot accept any responsibility for damage that may result from
this. Further information about tyres,
wheels and approved combinations can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
If you use tyres other than those tested and
recommended for Mercedes-Benz vehicles, characteristics such as handling, vehicle noise emissions and fuel consumption
may be adversely affected. In addition, the
wheels may come into contact with the
body or axle components when heavily loaded or when driving with snow chains. This
could result in damage to the tyres or the
vehicle.
! Retreaded tyres are neither tested nor
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since
previous damage cannot always be detected on retreaded tyres. As a result,
Mercedes-Benz cannot guarantee vehicle
safety if retreaded tyres are fitted. Do not
fit used tyres if you have no information
about their previous usage.
G Risk of accident
If wheels or tyres other than those which
have been tested are fitted:
Rthe brakes or chassis components could
be damaged.
Rwheel
and tyre clearances can no longer
be guaranteed.
This could cause an accident.
Modification work on the brake system and
wheels is not permitted, nor is the use of
spacer plates or brake dust shields. This inva-
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 177
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Tyres and wheels
lidates the General Operating Permit for the
vehicle.
Notes on selecting, fitting and replacing
tyres
ROnly
fit tyres and wheels of the same type
and make.
ROnly
fit tyres of the correct size onto the
wheels.
RAfter
fitting new tyres, run them in at moderate speeds for the first 100 km as they
only reach their full performance after this
distance.
RFit
new tyres on the front wheels first if
tyres of the same size are required on the
front and rear wheels.
RReplace
the tyres after six years at the latest, regardless of wear. This also applies to
the spare wheel*.
RDo not drive with tyres which have too little
tread depth as this significantly reduces
the traction on wet roads (aquaplaning).
! Store tyres that are not being used in a
cool, dry and preferably dark place. Protect
the tyres against oil, grease, petrol and diesel.
* optional
Notes on regularly inspecting wheels
and tyres
RRegularly
check the wheels and tyres of
your vehicle for damage (e.g. cuts, punctures, tears, bulges on tyres and deformation,
cracks or severe corrosion on wheels), at
least every 14 days, as well as after driving
off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels could cause a loss of tyre pressure.
RRegularly
check the tyre tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the whole
width of the tyre (Y page 178). If necessary, turn the front wheels to full lock in
order to inspect the inner side of the tyre
surface.
RAll wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture.
RRegularly
check the pressure of all your
tyres including the spare tyre*, particularly
prior to long trips, and correct the pressure
as necessary (Y page 178).
Notes on driving
RWhile
driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or tyres are damaged.
If you suspect that a tyre is defective,
reduce your speed and stop the vehicle as
soon as possible to check the wheels and
tyres for damage. Hidden tyre damage
could also be causing the unusual handling
characteristics. If you find no signs of damage, have the wheels and tyres examined
at a specialist workshop, for example at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
RWhen
parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tyres do not get deformed by the kerb
or other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over kerbs, speed humps or similar, try to
do so slowly and at an obtuse angle. Otherwise, the tyres, particularly the sidewalls,
could get damaged.
Direction of rotation
Tyres with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of aquaplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tyre indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
i You may fit a spare tyre* against the
direction of rotation.
Z
177
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 178
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Tyres and wheels
MOExtended run-flat system*
The MOExtended run-flat system allows you
to continue driving the vehicle even when one
or more tyres lose all air pressure.
The MOExtended run-flat system may only be
used in combination with the tyre pressure
loss warning system and only on wheels specifically tested and approved by MercedesBenz.
i Vehicles with MOExtended run-flat sys-
tem are not equipped with the TIREFIT
kit*24.
Therefore, it is recommended that you
equip your vehicle additionally with the
TIREFIT kit* when fitting tyres that do not
feature run-flat properties, e.g. winter
tyres.
i A TIREFIT kit* is available from any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
You will find notes on driving with a flat tyre
in the "Practical advice" section
(Y page 262).
24 Only
178
Tyre tread
G Risk of accident
Bear in mind that:
Rtyre grip decreases rapidly on wet roads
when the tread depth is less than 3 mm.
Thus, you should replace tyres that have
insufficient tread.
Rwinter tyres should be replaced when the
tread depth is 4 mm or less as they will
no longer provide adequate grip.
Rthe
tread on a tyre may not wear evenly.
Thus, you should regularly check the
tread depth and the condition of the
tread across the entire width of all tyres.
If necessary, turn the steering wheel so
that you can see the tyre tread more easily.
Otherwise, you could lose control of the
vehicle and cause an accident due to the
reduced grip of the tyres on the road.
Tyre pressures
i You will find a table of tyre pressures for
various operating conditions on the inside
of your vehicle's fuel filler flap.
The valid value for the spare wheel* is stated on the spare wheel and in the technical
data section.
G Risk of accident
Tyre pressure that is either too high or too
low has a negative effect on the vehicle’s
driving safety, which could lead you to
cause an accident. Therefore, you should
regularly check the pressure of all your
tyres (including the spare tyre*), particularly prior to long trips, and correct the
pressure as necessary.
To test tyre pressure, use a suitable pressure
gauge. The outer appearance of a tyre does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the
tyre pressure.
G Risk of accident
Should the tyre pressure drop repeatedly:
for certain countries.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 179
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Tyres and wheels
RCheck
the tyre for foreign bodies.
RCheck
whether the wheel is losing air or
the valve is leaking.
Tyre pressure that is too low has a negative
effect on the vehicle’s active safety, which
could lead to your causing an accident.
Tyre pressure changes by approximately
0.1 bar for every 10 °C change in ambient
temperature.
If you measure the tyre pressure in enclosed
spaces where the temperature differs from
the outside temperature, you will have to correct the measured value accordingly.
When the vehicle is driven, the tyre temperature, and with it the tyre pressure, will
increase depending on the road speed and
the load on the tyres.
Therefore, you should only correct tyre pressures when the tyres are cold.
The pressure of warm tyres should only be
corrected if it is too low for the current operating conditions.
Driving with tyre pressure that is too high or
too low can:
Rshorten
the service life of the tyres
Rincrease
the likelihood of tyre damage
Rhave
a negative effect on handling characteristics (e.g. by causing aquaplaning)
i The tyre pressure values given for low
loads are minimum values which offer you
good ride comfort characteristics.
However, you can also use the values given
for higher loads. These are permissible and
will not adversely affect the running of the
vehicle.
H Environmental note
Check the tyre pressure regularly, at least
every 14 days.
Tyre pressure loss warning system
While the vehicle is in motion, the tyre pressure loss warning system monitors the set
tyre pressure using the rotational speed of
the wheels. This enables the system to detect
significant pressure loss in a tyre. If the speed
of rotation of a wheel changes as a result of
a loss of pressure, a corresponding warning
message will appear in the multi-function display.
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not warn you of an incorrectly set tyre pressure. The table on the inside of the fuel filler
flap will help you decide whether the tyre
pressures should be corrected.
The tyre pressure loss warning system does
not replace the need to regularly check
your vehicle's tyre pressures, since an even
loss of pressure on several tyres at the
same time cannot be detected by the tyre
pressure loss warning system.
The tyre pressure loss warning system is
not able to warn you of a sudden loss of
pressure, e.g. if the tyre is penetrated by a
foreign object.
In the event of a sudden loss of pressure,
bring the vehicle to a halt by braking care-
179
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 180
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Tyres and wheels
fully. Do not make any sudden steering
movements when doing so.
The function of the tyre pressure loss warning
system is limited or delayed if:
Rsnow chains are fitted to your vehicle's
tyres.
Rroad
Ryou
conditions are wintry.
are driving on sand or gravel.
Ryou
adopt a very sporty driving style (cornering at high speeds or driving with high
rates of acceleration).
Ryou are towing a very heavy or large trailer.
Ryou
are driving with a heavy load (in the
vehicle or on the roof).
Restarting the tyre pressure loss warning system
Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
if you have:
Rchanged the tyre pressure
Rchanged
Rfitted
X
the wheels or tyres
new wheels or tyres
Before restarting, consult the table of tyre
pressures on the inside of the fuel filler flap
to ensure that the tyre pressure in all four
180
tyres is set correctly for the operating conditions concerned.
X Also observe the notes in the section on
tyre pressures (Y page 178).
G Risk of accident
The tyre pressure loss warning system can
only give reliable warnings if you have set
the correct tyre pressure.
If an incorrect tyre pressure is set, these
incorrect values will be monitored.
A tyre with insufficient pressure results in
vehicle instability when driving, thus
increasing the risk of an accident.
Make sure that the key is in position
2 (Y page 62) in the ignition lock.
You will see the following message on the
standard screen of the multi-function display (Y page 100)
X Press k or j to select the tyre pressure function:
Run Flat Indicator active
Menu: R-Button
X Press the reset button on the left of the
instrument cluster.
The following message appears in the
multi-function display:
X
Restart Run Flat Indicat.? Yes Cancel
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X Press the æ button.
The following message appears in the
multi-function display:
Run Flat Indicator restarted
After a teach-in period, the tyre pressure
loss warning system will monitor the set
tyre pressures of all four tyres.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X Press the ç button.
or
X Wait until the message
Restart Run Flat Indicator?
Yes Cancel disappears.
The tyre pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 181
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Winter driving
Interchanging the wheels
G Risk of accident
Interchange the front and rear wheels only
if they have the same dimensions: for example size, offset, etc.
After every wheel interchange/change,
have the tightening torque checked at a
qualified specialist workshop that has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools
to carry out the work required. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
The wheels could work loose if they are not
tightened to a torque of 130 Nm.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use wheel bolts of the
correct size which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
The wear patterns on the front and rear tyres
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Interchange the wheels before a clear wear
pattern has formed on the tyres. Front tyres
typically wear more on the shoulders and the
rear tyres in the centre.
Interchange the wheels every 5,000 km to
10,000 km depending on the degree of tyre
wear, provided that the vehicle has the same
size front and rear tyres. Do not reverse the
direction of tyre rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is changed. Check the tyre pressure and, if
necessary, restart the tyre pressure loss
warning system.
Winter driving
Points to remember
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, at the onset of winter.
Winter tyres
Use winter tyres at temperatures below +7 °C
and on snow or ice-covered roads. Only then
can the effect of the ABS and ESP® driving
systems be ensured in winter too.
Use winter tyres of the same make and tread
on all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
G Risk of accident
Winter tyres with a tread depth of less than
4 mm must be replaced immediately. They
are no longer suitable for winter use and
can no longer provide sufficient grip. This
could cause you to lose control of your
vehicle and cause an accident.
Always observe the maximum permitted
speed specified for the winter tyres you have
fitted. If you fit winter tyres which have a
lower maximum permitted speed than that of
the vehicle, affix an appropriate warning sign
181
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 182
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Winter driving
in the driver's field of vision. This can be
obtained at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. from a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Under these circumstances, you should also
restrict the maximum speed of the vehicle
using permanent Speedtronic*25 to the maximum permissible speed for the winter tyres
(Y page 120).
Once you have fitted the winter tyres:
X Check the tyre pressures (Y page 178).
G Risk of accident
If you fit the spare wheel* when driving with
winter tyres, bear in mind that driving stability will be impaired owing to unstable
cornering characteristics caused by the different tyres. You should therefore adapt
your driving style and drive carefully.
Have the spare wheel* replaced at the
nearest qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related sys-
tems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Snow chains
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains which
have been specially approved for your vehicle
by Mercedes-Benz, or are of a corresponding
standard of quality.
You may only fit snow chains as a pullingaway aid. Only use fine-link snow chains.
When snow chains are fitted, you may only
drive straight ahead. The snow chains could
otherwise come into contact with the bodywork when you turn the front wheels.
When snow chains are fitted, you cannot use
Active Park Assist* (Y page 123).
Do not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 50 km/h.
! Information about the use of snow chaincompatible AMG winter tyres is applicable
for AMG tyres. Use of snow chains is only
permissible with these tyres.
If you intend to fit snow chains, please bear
the following points in mind:
Rsnow chains cannot be fitted to all wheel/
tyre combinations.
Rsnow
chains must not be fitted to emergency spare wheels, e.g. on a "Minispare"
emergency spare wheel.
RFit snow chains only in pairs and only to the
front wheels. Comply with the manufacturer's installation instructions.
Winter driving
G Risk of accident
Do not shift down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This
could cause the drive wheels to lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid.
You should drive particularly carefully on slippery road surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering and braking manoeuvres.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
! Vehicles with 17" tyres
25 Only
182
available for certain countries.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 183
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Driving tips
Vehicles with manual transmission: engage
neutral.
X Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*: shift the
selector lever to N.
X Try to bring the vehicle under control using
corrective steering.
X
Driving tips
Downhill gradients
Rolling with the engine switched off
On long and steep downhill stretches, especially if the vehicle is laden or towing a trailer,
you must shift to a lower gear in good time or,
on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*, select shift
range 1, 2 or 3.
G Risk of accident
Never switch the engine off while the vehicle is in motion.
There is no power assistance for the steering and the service brake when the engine
is not running.
You will require considerably more effort to
steer and brake and, therefore, you could
lose control of the vehicle and cause an
accident.
cruise control* or Speedtronic*.
Braking
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
the speed. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
G Risk of accident
Heavy and light loads
Do not change down for additional engine
braking on a slippery road surface. This
could cause the drive wheels to lose their
grip and the vehicle could skid.
G Risk of accident
Make sure that other road users are not
endangered by your braking.
* optional
i This also applies if you have activated
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately, but
drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously while the vehicle is in motion, e.g.
never cause the brakes to rub by applying
constant slight pedal pressure. This causes
the brake system to overheat, increases
183
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 184
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Driving tips
the braking distance and can lead to the
brakes failing completely.
If the brakes have been used only moderately,
you should occasionally test their effectiveness. To do this, brake more firmly from a
higher speed. This improves the grip of the
brakes.
Wet roads
If driving in heavy rain for a prolonged period
of time without braking, there may be a
delayed reaction from the brakes, when braking for the first time. You must brake harder.
You must therefore maintain a greater distance from the vehicle in front.
Brake firmly after driving on a wet road. This
way the brake discs will become warm, drying
more quickly, which will protect them against
corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salted
roads
G Risk of accident
The layer of salt on the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings may cause a delay in
the braking effect, resulting in a signifi-
184
cantly longer braking distance, which could
lead to an accident.
To avoid this danger, you should:
Roccasionally brake carefully, without putting other road users at risk, when you
are driving on salted roads. This helps to
remove any salt that may have started to
build up on the brake discs and the brake
pads/linings.
G Risk of accident
New brake pads/linings only reach their
optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometres of driving. Before this optimum braking effect is reached, you should
compensate for the reduced braking effect
by applying greater pressure when braking.
This also applies after the brake discs or the
brake pads/linings have been replaced.
Rmaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead and drive with particular care.
Rcarefully apply the brakes at the end of a
trip and immediately after commencing a
new trip, so that salt residues are
removed from the brake disc.
New brake pads/linings
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only have brake pads/linings
fitted to your vehicle which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which correspond to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake pads/linings which have not
been approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which are not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Tyre grip
G Risk of accident
Whereas the vehicle can be fully controlled
at a certain speed on dry roads, you must
reduce your speed on wet or icy roads to
achieve the same road safety. Otherwise,
you could cause an accident.
Pay particular attention to the road conditions at temperatures around freezing
point.
If ice has formed on the road surface (e.g.
from fog), a light film of water rapidly forms
on the ice when you brake, considerably
reducing tyre grip. Drive with particular
care in such weather conditions.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 185
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Driving abroad
Driving on wet roads
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of aquaplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou drive at low speeds
Rthe
tyres have adequate tread depth
For this reason, do not drive in tyre ruts, and
brake carefully.
Driving on flooded roads
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe maximum permitted still water depth is
25 cm.
Ryou
should drive no faster than at walking
pace.
! Bear in mind that vehicles travelling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
You must observe these notes. Otherwise,
damage may occur to the engine, electrics
and transmission.
* optional
Driving abroad
! Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use genuine Mercedes-Benz masking
tape. Your headlamps could otherwise be
damaged.
Remove the masking tape when you are
once again driving on the same side of the
road as in the country in which your vehicle
is registered.
Points to remember
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. The
Service Hotline's current telephone numbers
for use when you are abroad are to be found
in the "Service24h" chapter of the Service
Booklet.
Only low-octane fuel is available in certain
countries.
You can find further information about fuel
grades on (Y page 168).
Symmetrical dipped beam
If your journey takes you to countries where
vehicles are driven on sides of the road opposite to the country in which the vehicle is registered, your headlamps must be switched to
symmetrical dipped beam or be partially
masked. Oncoming traffic will be dazzled
less.
X Vehicles with halogen headlamps: mask
the headlamps with special masking tape.
X
Vehicles with projection and bi-xenon
headlamps*: have the headlamps
switched over at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
G Risk of accident
Have your headlamps switched back to
asymmetrical dipped beam if you are driving in a country in which traffic drives on
the same side of the road as in the country
in which your vehicle was registered. Otherwise, you may dazzle the oncoming traffic
and could cause an accident.
i You can obtain this masking tape from a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Z
185
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 186
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Trailer towing*
Trailer towing*
Fitting the ball coupling
X
Make a note of the ball coupling key number.
i You can use this number to obtain a
replacement key from a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
If the ball coupling does not engage properly when it is attached, the vehicle/trailer
combination is not secured and could
become detached. You could therefore
cause an accident. Attach the ball coupling
carefully and make sure that it engages.
Vehicles without ECO start/stop function: the attachable ball coupling is on the
right of the stowage compartment in the luggage compartment (Y page 161).
X Open the stowage compartment on the
right-hand side of the luggage compartment.
X Fold the trim downwards.
Vehicles without ECO start/stop function
1 Ball coupling
Vehicles with ECO start/stop function
1 Ball coupling
2 Retainer strap
2 Ball coupling recess
Undo retainer strap 2.
X Remove ball coupling 1 from the ball coupling recess.
Vehicles with ECO start/stop function*:
the attachable ball coupling is in the ball coupling recess in the stowage well underneath
the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 201).
X Open the luggage compartment floor.
X
X
Remove ball coupling 1 from the ball coupling recess.2
1 Protective cap
186
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 187
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Trailer towing*
Pull protective cap 1 down in the direction
of the arrow out of the ball coupling recess.
X Place protective cap 1 into the ball coupling recess.
X
3 Ball coupling recess
4 Handwheel
Pull handwheel 4 away from the ball coupling and turn it clockwise until it engages.
The green area on the ball coupling is
aligned with the red mark on the handwheel.
X Insert the ball coupling in the direction of
the arrow into ball coupling recess 3 until
it engages.
Handwheel 4 turns so that green mark
5 on the handwheel is aligned with green
area 6 on the ball coupling.
X
1 Key
2 Protective cap
Pull protective cap 2 off the lock in the
handwheel.
X Insert key 1 into the ignition lock.
The red mark on the handwheel must be
aligned with the green area on the ball coupling (fitting position). If this is not the case:
X Turn key 1 in the direction of the arrow.
The key is released.
X
1 Key
2 Protective cap
5 Green mark on the handwheel
6 Green area on the ball coupling
Turn key 1 to the stop in the direction of
the arrow to lock.
X Remove key 1.
X Press protective cap 2 onto the lock.
X
i You can store the key in the ball coupling
stowage compartment in the luggage compartment.
Z
* optional
187
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 188
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Trailer towing*
1 Trailer power socket
X
Fold trailer power socket 1 down.
G Risk of accident
The ball coupling is only securely mounted
when the green mark on the handwheel is
aligned with the green area on the ball coupling and the key can be removed. If the ball
coupling is not securely mounted, it may
come loose.
The ball coupling must be locked and the
key must be removed when towing a trailer.
This is the only way to guarantee that the
ball coupling is secured and cannot come
loose while the vehicle is in motion. If the
ball coupling cannot be locked and the key
cannot be removed, remove the ball coupling and clean it.
188
If the ball coupling can still not be fitted
(locked) after it has been cleaned, remove
the ball coupling. The trailer coupling must
then not be used to tow a trailer, as safe
operation is not guaranteed.
Have the entire trailer coupling checked at
a qualified specialist workshop. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Notes on towing a trailer
G Risk of accident
When reversing the vehicle towards the
trailer, make sure there is nobody between
the trailer and the vehicle.
Couple and uncouple the trailer carefully. If
you do not couple the trailer to the towing
vehicle correctly, the trailer could become
detached.
Make sure that the following values are not
exceeded:
Rthe
permissible trailer drawbar noseweight
Rthe
permissible trailer load
Rthe permissible rear axle load of the tow-
ing vehicle
Rthe
maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight of both the towing vehicle and the
trailer
You will find the applicable permissible values, which must not be exceeded, in the
vehicle documents.
You will find the values approved by the
manufacturer on the vehicle identification
plates and those for the towing vehicle in
the "Technical data" section.
You will find installation dimensions and loads
in the "Technical data" section
(Y page 290).
The maximum permissible trailer drawbar
noseweight on the ball coupling is 75 kg.
However, the actual drawbar load must not
exceed the value given on the trailer coupling
and trailer identification plates. The lowest
weight applies.
! Use a noseweight as close as possible to
the maximum permissible noseweight. Do
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 189
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Trailer towing*
not use a noseweight of less than 50 kg,
otherwise the trailer may come loose.
Bear in mind that the payload and the rear
axle load are reduced by the actual noseweight.
i The height of the ball coupling changes
with the load of the vehicle. If necessary,
use a trailer with a height-adjustable drawbar.
Coupling up a trailer
G Risk of injury
Do not connect a trailer with an engaged
overrun brake. Otherwise, your hand could
become trapped between the bumper and
drawbar.
! Do not disconnect a trailer with an
engaged overrun brake. Otherwise your
vehicle could be damaged by the spring
action of the overrun brake.
Position the trailer level behind the vehicle.
X Couple up the trailer.
X Establish the electrical connection
between the vehicle and the trailer.
X
* optional
Driving tips
In Germany, the maximum permitted speed
for vehicle/trailer combinations is 80 km/h.
G Risk of accident
A maximum speed of 80 km/h should not
be exceeded, even in countries where
higher speeds are permitted for vehicle/
trailer combinations. This lowers the risk of
an accident.
When towing a trailer, your vehicle's handling
characteristics will be different in comparison
to when driving without a trailer.
The vehicle/trailer combination:
Ris heavier
Ris
restricted in its acceleration and gradient-climbing capability
Rhas
Ris
an increased braking distance
affected more by strong crosswinds
Rdemands
more sensitive steering
Rconsumes
more fuel
On long and steep downhill gradients, you
must select a lower gear in good time, or in
vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*, select shift
range 1, 2 or 3.
i This also applies if you have activated
cruise control* or Speedtronic*.
This will use the braking effect of the engine,
so less braking will be required to maintain
the speed. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheating and wearing too quickly. If you need
additional braking, depress the brake pedal
repeatedly rather than continuously.
G Risk of accident
Never depress the brake pedal continuously while the vehicle is in motion, e.g.
never cause the brakes to rub by applying
constant slight pedal pressure. This causes
the brake system to overheat, increases
the braking distance and can lead to the
brakes failing completely.
Driving tips
RMaintain a greater distance from the vehicle in front than when driving without a
trailer.
RAvoid
braking abruptly. If possible, brake
gently at first to allow the trailer to run on.
Then increase the braking force rapidly.
RThe
values given for gradient-climbing
capabilities from a standstill refer to sea
level. When driving in mountainous areas,
189
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 190
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Trailer towing*
note that the power output of the engine,
and consequently the vehicle's gradientclimbing capability, decrease with increasing altitude.
If the trailer swings from side to side:
X Do not accelerate.
X Do not counter-steer.
X Brake if necessary.
G Risk of accident
On no account should you attempt to draw
the vehicle/trailer combination out by
increasing speed.
Removing the ball coupling
Pull the protective cap off the lock in the
handwheel.
X Insert the key into the lock in the handwheel.
X Turn the key clockwise.
The lock is unlocked.
X Hold the ball coupling. Pull the handwheel
away from the ball coupling and turn it
clockwise until it engages.
The green area on the ball coupling is
aligned with the red mark on the handwheel.
X
190
Pull out the ball coupling downwards.
Clean the ball coupling if it is dirty.
X Vehicles without ECO start/stop function*: open the stowage compartment on
the right of the luggage compartment.
X Fold the trim downwards.
X Vehicles with start/stop function*:
open the luggage compartment floor.
X Remove the protective cap from the ball
coupling recess.
X Press the protective cap into the ball coupling recess until it engages.
X
Rbrake
X
Rchange
Storing the ball coupling
Store the ball coupling with the key inserted in the ball coupling recess.
X Vehicle without ECO start/stop function: Secure the ball coupling in place using
the retainer strap.
X
G Risk of accident
Never transport an unsecured ball coupling
in the interior of the vehicle.
Otherwise, vehicle occupants could be
injured by the ball coupling being thrown if
you:
Rhave
sharply
direction suddenly
an accident
Trailer power supply
When it leaves the factory, your vehicle's
trailer socket outlet is equipped with a permanent power supply and a power supply that
is switched on via the ignition lock.
The permanent power supply is supplied via
trailer socket pin 9.
The power supply that is switched on via the
ignition lock is supplied via trailer socket pin
10.
! You can connect consumers with a power
rating of up to 240 W to the permanent
power supply and up to 180 W to the power
supply that is switched on via the ignition
lock.
You must not charge a trailer battery using
the power supply.
The trailer's turn signal lamps are only guaranteed to function when bulbs are used.
You can obtain further information about
installing the trailer electrics from a qualified
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 191
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Service
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X To switch the switched power supply on
or off: turn the key in the ignition lock to
position 2 or 0, respectively.
Trailer with 7-pin connector
If your trailer has a 7-pin connector, you can
connect it to the 13-pin socket on the ball
coupling using an adapter or, if necessary, an
adapter cable. Both of these can be obtained
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Fold down socket .
Open the socket cover.
X Insert the connector with lug 1 into
groove 2 on the socket and turn the connector clockwise to the stop.
X Make the cover engage.
X If you are using an adapter cable, secure
the cable to the trailer with cable ties.
X
X
! Make sure that there is sufficient cable
Service
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
The ASSYST PLUS service indicator informs
you of the next service due date. The multifunction display shows the service due date:
Service A due in ..days
Service A due in .. km
Service A due now
play so that the cable cannot become
detached when cornering.
Fitting the adapter
Next service due (example)
1 Connector with lug
2 Socket with groove
The letter indicates how much time the workshop will require to carry out the service work.
The letters displayed range from A for a short
service duration to H for a long service duration.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval indicator
does not take into account any periods of
191
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 192
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
X
Note down the service due date displayed
before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
Subtract the battery disconnection periods
from the service date shown on the display
after reconnecting the battery.
Fading out the service message
Service due date exceeded
The multi-function display shows one of the
following messages:
Service A overdue by .. days
Service A overdue by .. km
You will also hear a warning tone.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre, will reset the
ASSYST PLUS service indicator after the necessary service work has been carried out.
i If you fail to have the service performed
by the specified date, you may be violating
applicable laws. Your warranty may be invalidated and goodwill settlements may be
refused.
Calling up the service due date
X
Press reset button 1.
192
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
X Switch on the ignition.
X Press the è or ÿ button to select the
standard display (Y page 103).
X Press the j or k button to select the
service information.
The multi-function display shows the
9 symbol and the service due date.
Care
Notes on care
Regular and proper care maintains the value
of your vehicle.
i It is advisable to use Mercedes-Benz care
products.
Scratches, corrosive deposits, areas affected
by corrosion and damage caused by inadequate care cannot always be completely
repaired. In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Repair damage caused by loose chippings
and remove the following substances immediately, whilst avoiding rubbing too hard:
RSoak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off afterwards.
RSoak
bird droppings with water and rinse
off afterwards.
RRemove
tree resin, oils, fuels and greases
by rubbing gently with a cloth soaked in
petroleum ether or lighter fluid.
RUse
silicone remover to remove wax.
RUse
tar remover to remove tar stains.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 193
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging, cleaning
cloths and polishing wads in an environmentally responsible manner.
! Do not affix to painted surfaces or plastic
surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
Rscented
plates
oil bottle or similar items
You could otherwise damage the paint finish or plastic.
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windscreen and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away leading to corrosion damage.
Vehicle care
! Do not park the vehicle for a long period
of time directly after cleaning, especially if
the wheels have just been cleaned with a
wheel cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
rapid corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. After cleaning, park
the vehicle when it is at normal operating
temperature.
Automatic car wash
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the beginning.
! Do not use a touch-free automatic car
wash that uses chemical agents to wash
the vehicle.
Preferably use automatic car washes with
high-pressure jets for pre-washing.
If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before
cleaning it in an automatic car wash.
! Make sure that the automatic car wash is
suitable for the size of the vehicle. Fold in
the exterior mirrors before the vehicle is
washed. There is otherwise a risk of damage to the exterior mirrors.
! Make sure that the side windows are com-
pletely closed, that the ventilation/heater
blower is fully turned off and that the windscreen wiper switch is set to 0. The rain
sensor may otherwise be activated, triggering unintended wiper movements. This
could cause damage to the vehicle.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax and drying agents from the windscreen
and the wiper blades. This will prevent smears
and reduce wiping noises caused by residue
on the windscreen.
High-pressure cleaners
G Risk of accident
Do not use high-pressure cleaners with circular-jet nozzles (dirt grinders) to clean
your vehicle or ― especially ― the tyres.
Otherwise, you could damage the tyres and
cause an accident.
! Observe the instructions issued by the
equipment manufacturer concerning the
distance to be maintained between the
nozzle of the high-pressure cleaner and the
vehicle (at least 30 cm).
Move the high-pressure cleaner nozzle
around when cleaning your vehicle.
193
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 194
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
RBattery
Turn the key to position 1 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X Set the windscreen wipers to position
I (Y page 83) on the combination switch.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 62) or
remove it when the wiper arms are vertical.
Rconnectors
! Only fold the windscreen wipers away
i Anti-glare film retrofitted to the insides of
Fold the wiper arms away from the windscreen.
X Wipe the windscreen and wiper blades with
a damp, lint-free cloth (e.g. a microfibre
cloth) and cleaning agent.
X Fold the wiper arms back on to the windscreen before the ignition is switched on.
Cleaning the headlamps
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtyres
Rdoor
joint
Relectrical
components
Rlights
elements
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to failures or leaks.
Cleaning the wiper blades and the outside of the windscreen
G Risk of injury
Before cleaning the windscreen or wiper
blades, turn the key in the ignition to 0.
Otherwise, the windscreen wipers may
move and injure you.
X
! Do not clean the wiper blades too often
as this will result in damage to the surface
coating, leading to wiper noise.
Cleaning the windows
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Clean the insides of the windows with a
damp cloth or commercially-available glass
194
the windows could interfere with radio or
mobile phone reception, especially if it is
conductive or metal-coated film. Information about anti-glare film can be obtained
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
from the windscreen when vertical, otherwise you will damage the bonnet.
Rseals
Rtrim
cleaner. Avoid touching the inside of the
rear windscreen and the side windows with
hard objects, e.g. ice scrapers or rings. You
could otherwise cause damage to the windows, rear window heating or aerial on the
rear window.
X
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the headlamps
with a damp sponge.
! Only use washer fluid which is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses. Unsuitable washer
fluid could damage the plastic lamp lenses
of the headlamps.
Therefore, do not use:
Rdry
cloths
Rabrasive
products
Rsolvents
Rcleaning
products containing solvents
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 195
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
You could otherwise scratch or damage the
surface of the lenses.
Cleaning the plastic trim
! Do not use dry, coarse or hard cloths and
do not scrub. Doing so will scratch or damage the surfaces.
! In order to protect the vehicle's high-quality surfaces and to retain the overall
appearance, avoid contact with cosmetics
and suntan lotion.
Wipe plastic parts with a damp, lint-free
cloth (e.g. a microfibre cloth).
X Light soiling: use a low-foaming soap (e.g.
a light liquid hand soap) diluted in water.
X Heavy soiling: use a cleaning agent that is
solvent-free and non-corrosive. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz cleaning product for this
purpose.
X
Cleaning the steering wheel boss and
dashboard
Moisten a clean lint-free cloth with water.
Clean the plastic parts and the dashboard.
X If particularly dirty, use a mild detergent.
X
X
* optional
G Risk of injury
Do not use cleaners and cockpit care
sprays containing solvents to clean the
cockpit and steering wheel boss. Cleaners
containing solvents cause the surface to
become porous and in the event of an airbag being triggered, plastic parts that have
become loose could cause considerable
injuries.
Cleaning the leather upholstery*
! Cleaning
RClean
genuine leather covers using a
damp cloth, then wipe the covers down
using a dry cloth. Make sure that the
leather does not become soaked. For
leather care, use leather care foam A 001
986 59 71 10. You can purchase this
from any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
RClean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e. g. washing-up liquid).
RClean
fabric covers with a microfibre
cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. washing-up liquid).
When cleaning, take care not to rub too
vigorously and always wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
Leave the seat to dry afterwards. Cleaning results depend on the type of dirt and
how long it has been there.
RClean
Alcantara covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure you wipe entire seat
sections to avoid leaving visible lines.
i Note that leather covers are a natural
product and as such are subject to a natural
ageing process and may react differently
(e.g. increased wrinkling) to certain environmental influences (such as high humidity, intense heat).
Note that regular care is essential to ensure
that the quality (both appearance and comfort) of the covers is retained over time.
Cleaning the trim strips (three-door
vehicles)
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the trim strips below the side
windows. You may otherwise damage the
surface of the trim strips.
Cleaning the padded table*
The plastic parts of the padded table can be
cleaned using a detergent solution.
195
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 196
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
The fabric cover can be cleaned using a detergent solution or an upholstery cleaner.
i The cover cannot be removed.
Cleaning Parktronic*
The sensors are located in the front and rear
bumpers.
Cleaning the exhaust tail pipes
Dirt combined with the effects of road grit and
corrosive environmental factors may cause
flash rust to form on the surface.
Regular care of the exhaust tail pipes will
ensure that their original shine is restored.
Trailer coupling*
The ball coupling must be cleaned if it
becomes dirty or corroded.
X Remove any rust using a wire brush.
X Remove dirt with a clean, lint-free cloth or
a brush.
! Do not clean the ball coupling with a highpressure cleaner. Do not use solvents.
! Do not clean exhaust tail pipes with alkaline-based cleaning agents such as wheel
cleaner.
Use the chrome-cleaning agent recommended by Mercedes-Benz for cleaning. Information about chrome-cleaning agents can
be obtained from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
1 Parktronic* sensors in the left-hand side
of the front bumper.
X
Clean sensors 1 in the bumper with water,
car shampoo and a soft cloth.
! Do not use dry, coarse or hard cloths and
do not scrub. You will otherwise scratch or
damage the sensors. If you intend to use a
high-pressure cleaner or a steam cleaner to
clean the sensors, observe the instructions
issued by the equipment manufacturer
concerning the distance to be maintained
between the nozzle of the high-pressure
cleaner and the vehicle.
196
1 Locking balls
2 Guide pin
3 Guide faces
4 Release lever
5 Ball neck head
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 197
Version: 2.10.6
Operation
Care
Lightly oil or grease positions 1 to 5 and
the ball coupling recess of the vehicle after
cleaning.
X Treat the lock with an oil that is acid and
resin-free.
X Check that the vehicle's trailer coupling is
working properly.
X
! Observe the note on care provided by the
trailer manufacturer.
i Maintenance of the ball coupling and
trailer coupling can also be performed by
any Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
H Environmental note
Dispose of oily and greasy cloths in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Z
197
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
198
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 198
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 199
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Where will I find...? ...........................
Display messages .............................
Troubleshooting ................................
Locking/unlocking in an emergency .................................................
Changing the batteries .....................
Changing the bulbs ...........................
Replacing the wiper blades ..............
Flat tyre .............................................
Battery ...............................................
Jump-starting ....................................
Towing and tow-starting ..................
Fuses ..................................................
200
202
222
241
244
245
251
253
263
266
268
271
199
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 200
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Where will I find...?
Where will I find...?
Vehicle tool kit, TIREFIT kit, jack, firstaid kit, warning triangle and folding
wheel chock
4 Vehicle tool kit and folding wheel chock
5 TIREFIT kit
First-aid kit
The vehicle tool kit, TIREFIT kit, jack, first-aid
kit, warning triangle and folding wheel chock
are located in the left-hand stowage compartment in the luggage compartment.
i Check the expiry date on the first-aid kit
i When using the jack, you should also
Removing the first-aid kit
observe the safety notes in the "Flat tyre"
section (Y page 253).
regularly, and replace the contents if necessary.
X
X
Remove the retaining cross.
Remove first-aid kit 1.
Warning triangle
Fold the stowage space cover down
(Y page 161).
X Release the Velcro fastening.
X Remove warning triangle 3.
X
1 First-aid kit (electric air pump behind it)
2 Jack
3 Warning triangle
200
Setting up the warning triangle
1 Retainer
2 Side reflectors
3 Feet
X
X
Fold feet 3 down and out to the side.
Pull side reflectors 2 upwards to form a
triangle and lock them at the top using
retainer 1.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 201
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Where will I find...?
Setting up the foldable wheel chock
The folding wheel chock serves as an additional measure for securing the vehicle
against rolling away, e.g. when a wheel is
being changed.
Fire extinguisher*
i Have the fire extinguisher refilled after
each use and checked every one or two
years. Otherwise, it may fail in an emergency.
Observe the legal requirements in all countries concerned.
Spare wheel*/"Minispare" emergency spare wheel*
X
Open the luggage compartment floor
(Y page 155).
Vehicles with ECO start/stop function*
The fire extinguisher is located underneath
the front of the driver's seat.
1 To fold the plates upwards
2 To fold out the lower plate
3 To insert the plate
Fold both plates 1 upwards.
Fold out lower plate 2.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
openings in base plate 3.
X
X
1 Tab
2 Fire extinguisher
X
X
Pull tab 1 upwards.
Remove fire extinguisher 2.
1 Ball coupling
2 Ball coupling stowage well
X
Remove ball coupling stowage well 2 and
ball coupling 1.
Z
* optional
201
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 202
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Vehicles without ECO start/stop function*
1 Retaining screw
2 Spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency
spare wheel
All vehicles
X
Turn retaining screw 1 anti-clockwise.
i Vehicles with a subwoofer mounted in the
emergency spare wheel:
You must observe the information labels on
the subwoofer when removing it.
X
Remove spare wheel/"Minispare" emergency spare wheel 2.
202
Display messages
Notes
The on-board computer shows warnings or
malfunctions in the multi-function display.
Certain display messages are accompanied
by a warning tone or a continuous tone.
The multi-function display shows high-priority
display messages in red. In the following
tables, these display messages are printed in
red.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional
notes in this Owner's Manual.
G Risk of accident
No further messages can be displayed if the
instrument cluster and/or the multi-function display fails.
This means that you will not see information
about the driving situation, such as the
speed, outside temperature, warning/indicator lamps, display messages or system
failures. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected. Adjust your driving
style and speed accordingly.
Immediately consult a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary special-
ist knowledge and tools to carry out the
work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
The following tables contain all the display
messages.
Hiding display messages
After a few seconds, the on-board computer
automatically hides some low priority display
messages. Other messages remain visible in
the multi-function display until you hide them
yourself.
Some high priority display messages cannot
be hidden. The multi-function display shows
these messages continuously until the causes of the messages have been remedied.
Use the buttons on the multi-function steering wheel.
X Use the è, ·, j or k button
to select another display.
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory
(Y page 106).
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 203
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Text messages
G Risk of accident and injury
If maintenance work is carried out incorrectly this can jeopardise the operating safety of your vehicle. You risk losing control of your vehicle
and thereby causing an accident. The safety systems may also no longer be able to protect you or others as they are designed to do.
Always have maintenance work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
In particular, all work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
203
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 204
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
120 km/h
Maximum speed
exceeded
ABS
ABS, ESP unavailable See Owner's
Manual
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
The maximum speed has been exceeded26.
X
Drive slower.
X
Carefully drive a short, lightly curving stretch
of road at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, ABS and
ESP® are available again.
G Risk of accident
ESP®
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) and
(Electronic Stability Program) are temporarily unavailable. The self-diagnosis is, for
example, not yet complete.
The following systems are also unavailable:
RBAS
(Brake Assist)
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
26 Only
204
for certain countries.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
preflight
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 205
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediABS and ESP® are temporarily unavailable
ately.
due to undervoltage. The battery is, for
X Observe the additional messages in the multiexample, not being charged.
function display (Y page 202).
The following systems are also unavailable:
G Risk of accident
X
RBAS
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
Z
205
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 206
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
ABS
Possible cause/consequence
ABS, ESP inoperative See Owner's
Manual
G Risk of accident
ABS and ESP® are unavailable due to a
fault.
The following systems are also unavailable:
RBAS
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
206
Possible solution
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
preflight
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 207
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
ESP
Possible cause/consequence
unavailable See
Owner's Manual
G Risk of accident
ESP® is temporarily unavailable. The selfdiagnosis is, for example, not yet complete.
The following systems are also unavailable:
Possible solution
X
Carefully drive a short, lightly curving stretch
of road at a speed above 20 km/h.
If the display message disappears, ESP® is
available again.
RBAS
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
Z
207
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 208
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
G Risk of accident
ESP® is unavailable due to undervoltage.
The battery is, for example, not being
charged.
The following systems are also unavailable:
RBAS
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
208
Possible solution
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional messages in the multifunction display (Y page 202).
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
preflight
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 209
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
ESP
Possible cause/consequence
inoperative See
Owner's Manual
Possible solution
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediESP® is unavailable due to a malfunction.
ately.
The following systems are also unavailable:
G Risk of accident
X
RBAS
Rthe steering assistant STEER CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning system
The brake system continues to function
normally, but without the functions listed
above.
Vehicle
Shift to N
* optional
Consult workshop
to start
The multi-function display additionally
shows an F in the position display.
Safe operation of AUTOTRONIC* can no
longer be fully guaranteed.
X
Stop in accordance with traffic conditions.
Move the selector lever to P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the
engine.
X Move the selector lever to position D or R.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have the transmission checked immediately at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*: the selector
lever is not in position N or P.
X
X
Move the selector lever to position N or P.
Z
209
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 210
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
No Service
Your vehicle is outside the network provider transmitter/receiver range.
X
Wait until the operational readiness symbol
appears in the multi-function display
(Y page 113).
The driver’s door is open and the driver's
seat belt has not been fastened.
X
Repeat the parking process with the seat belt
fastened and the driver's door closed.
You have inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel while steering
intervention was active.
X
Make sure that the multi-function steering
wheel is not touched while steering intervention is active.
The vehicle started to skid and ESP® intervened.
X
Use the Active Park Assist* system later.
You have just performed a large number
of turning or parking manoeuvres.
Active Park Assist* will become available again
after approximately 10 minutes.
X Stop in accordance with traffic conditions.
X Switch off and restart the engine.
X If the warning message does not disappear:
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC* is inoperative.
X
Park Assist
Park Assist
210
cancelled
inoperative
Observe the notes on PARKTRONIC* in the
"Troubleshooting" section (Y page 236).
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 211
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
Tyre press.
Check tyres
Stop the vehicle without making any sudden
steering or braking manoeuvres. Pay attention
The tyre pressure loss warning system has
to traffic conditions as you do so.
detected a significant loss in pressure.
X Check the tyres.
X Check the tyre pressure. If necessary, correct
the tyre pressure (Y page 178).
X If necessary, repair the faulty tyre or change
the wheel (Y page 253).
X Then restart the tyre pressure loss warning
system once the tyre pressure is correct
(Y page 179).
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is
faulty.
X
Check tyres
Then restart Run
Flat Indicator
A tyre pressure loss warning system display message appeared.
X
Run Flat Indicator
inoperative
The tyre pressure loss warning system is
faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
SRS
Restraint system
malfunction Consult workshop
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
G Risk of accident
G Risk of injury
There is a malfunction in the restraint system.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Correct the tyre pressure on all tyres
(Y page 178).
X Restart the tyre pressure loss warning system
(Y page 179).
Z
211
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 212
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Symbol messages
G Risk of accident and injury
If maintenance work is carried out incorrectly this can jeopardise the operating safety of your vehicle. You risk losing control of your vehicle
and thereby causing an accident. The safety systems may also no longer be able to protect you or others as they are designed to do.
Always have maintenance work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
In particular, all work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
<
G Risk of injury
X
Ask occupants in the rear to fasten their seat
belts.
If the symbol appears in the multi-function
Further
information on the status indicator for the
display, a seat belt buckle has been
rear
seat
belts* (Y page 76).
released on a rear seat during the journey.
1
2
±
The tailgate is open.
X
Close the tailgate.
At least one door is open.
X
Close the doors.
Some electronic systems are unable to
send information to the on-board computer. The following functions may be malfunctioning:
Rcoolant temperature display
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Rrev
counter
Rcruise
212
Possible solution
control* or Speedtronic* display
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 213
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
D
The engine fan is faulty.
X
#
The battery is not being charged. One (or
more) of the following could be the cause:
X
2
Brake wear
Ra
faulty alternator
Ra
torn poly-V-belt
Ra
malfunction in the electronics
If the coolant temperature is less than 120 †,
you can continue driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid subjecting the engine to heavy loads, e.g.
driving in mountainous terrain, and stop-andgo driving.
Stop immediately and safely when traffic conditions permit and switch off the engine.
X Check the poly-V-belt.
X If the poly-V-belt is torn: do not continue
driving. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X If the poly-V-belt is not damaged: have the
vehicle checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
The on-board voltage is too high.
X
Have the alternator checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The brake pads/linings have reached
their wear limit.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
213
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 214
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
3
Check brake fluid
level
!
Release parking
brake
You are driving with the parking brake
applied.
X
Release the parking brake.
[
Clean fuel filter
There is water in the fuel filter. The water
must be drained off27.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
D
Coolant Stop car,
turn eng. off
The coolant is too hot.
X
27 Only
214
for certain countries.
G Risk of accident
There is insufficient brake fluid in the
brake fluid reservoir.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not top up the brake fluid. This will not rectify the fault.
X
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch
off the engine, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Make sure, that the air supply to the radiator
is not blocked, e.g. by slush.
X Restart the engine only when the display message disappears. Otherwise, there is a risk of
engine damage.
X Pay attention to the coolant temperature display.
X If the temperature increases again, visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 215
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
The poly-V-belt may have torn.
X
X
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch
off the engine, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Check the poly-V-belt.
X If the poly-V-belt is torn: do not continue
driving. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X If the poly-V-belt is not damaged: do not
start the engine again until the display message disappears. Otherwise, there is a risk of
engine damage.
B
Top up coolant See
Owner's Manual
The coolant level is too low.
3
Power steer. malfunction Consult
workshop
Check whether you are able to apply the extra
force required.
There is no power assistance for the steerX If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive
ing. You will need to use more force to
on to a qualified specialist workshop.
steer.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive
The steering assistant STEER CONTROL is
on. Contact the nearest qualified specialist
also deactivated.
workshop.
G Risk of accident
Top up the coolant, observing the warning
notes before doing so (Y page 175).
X If the coolant needs topping up more often than
usual, have the engine coolant system checked
at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
215
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 216
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
.
Cornering light
left
or
Cornering light
right
The left-hand or right-hand cornering
light* is faulty.
X
.
Dipped-beam left
or
Dipped-beam right
Vehicles with the light and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand dippedbeam headlamp is faulty.
X
.
AUTO lights inoperative
The light sensor is faulty. The constant
headlamp mode (daytime driving lights) is
switched on.
X
.
Trailer turn signal left
or
Trailer turn signal right
The left-hand or right-hand trailer turn signal lamp is faulty.
X
Change the bulb.
.
Trailer tail lamp
left
or
Trailer tail lamp
right
The left-hand or right-hand trailer tail light
is faulty.
X
Change the bulb.
216
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
Halogen headlamp: replace the bulbs
(Y page 245).
X Bi-xenon headlamp*: visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Switch the lights to manual control in the onboard computer (Y page 109).
X Switch the lights on and off using the light
switch.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 217
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
.
Turn signal rear
left
or
Turn signal rear
right
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn
signal is faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
.
Turn signal left
mirror
or
Turn signal right
mirror
The turn signal in the left-hand or righthand exterior mirror is faulty. This display
message will only appear if all LEDs are
faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
.
Turn signal front
left
or
Turn signal front
right
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn
signal is faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
.
Brake/tail lamp
left
or
Brake/tail lamp
right
Vehicles with light and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand brake
lamp is faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
.
3rd brake lamp
Vehicles with the lights and visibility package*: the third brake lamp is faulty. The
display message will only appear if all
LEDs are faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
* optional
Z
217
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 218
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
.
Main-beam left
or
Main-beam right
Vehicles with light and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand high
beam is faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
.
Licence plate lamp
Vehicles with the lights and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand licence
plate lamp is faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
.
Switch off lights
The light is switched on when you leave
the vehicle.
X
Turn the light switch to M or U.
or
X
If the rear foglamp is switched on: press the
light switch in to the stop.
.
Foglamp left
or
Foglamp right
Vehicles with the lights and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand foglamp* is faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
.
Left-hand Tail
lamp/rear foglamp
or
Right-hand Tail
lamp/rear foglamp
Vehicles with lights and visibility package*: the tail lamp or the rear foglamp is
faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
.
Parking lamp front
left
or
Parking lamp front
right
Vehicles with the lights and visibility package*: the front left-hand or front righthand parking lamp is faulty.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
218
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 219
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
.
Reversing lamp
left
or
Reversing lamp
right
Vehicles with lights and visibility package*: the left-hand or right-hand reversing
light is faulty.
X
N
Add 1.0 litreof
engine oil when
next refuelling
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the oil level
is too low.
X
N
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the engine
Engine oil pressure Stop car, turn oil pressure is too low. There is a risk of
engine damage.
eng. off
X
N
Eng. oil level
Check level
Vehicles with a petrol engine: the oil level
is too low.
X
N
Eng. oil level Stop Vehicles with a diesel engine: the oil level
car, turn eng. off is too low. There is a risk of engine damage.
X
Change the bulb (Y page 245).
Check the oil level (Y page 173).
If necessary, top up the motor oil.
X Have the engine checked for leaks if the engine
oil needs topping up more often than usual.
X
Stop in accordance with traffic conditions.
Switch off the engine.
X Check the oil level (Y page 173).
X If necessary, top up the motor oil.
X
Check the oil level (Y page 173).
If necessary, top up the motor oil.
X Have the engine checked for leaks if the engine
oil needs topping up more often than usual.
X
Stop in accordance with traffic conditions.
Switch off the engine.
X Top up the engine oil and check the level
(Y page 173).
X
Z
* optional
219
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 220
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
N
Engine oil level
Reduce oil level
Vehicles with a diesel engine: you have
added too much engine oil. There is a risk
of damage to the engine or to the catalytic
converter.
X
Siphon off excess engine oil until it is at the
specified level. Observe the legal requirements.
N
Cannot measure oil
level
Vehicles with a diesel engine: the measuring system is faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
I
Key does not belong You have put the wrong key in the ignition
lock.
to vehicle
X
Use the correct key.
I
I
Ñ
Remove key
The key is in the ignition lock.
X
Remove the key.
Replace key
The key needs to be replaced.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
SPEEDTRONIC inoperative
Speedtronic* and cruise control* are
faulty.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
There is only a small amount of fuel in the
fuel tank.
X
Refuel at the nearest filling station.
¿
4
Reserve fuel level
The fuel level has fallen below the reserve
range.
X
Refuel at the nearest filling station.
t
Enter PIN
You have not yet logged on to your mobile
phone*.
X
Enter the PIN for the SIM card.
220
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 221
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Display messages
Display messages
Possible cause/consequence
Possible solution
t
Bluetooth ready
The Bluetooth connection between your
mobile phone and the audio system* or
COMAND APS* is not activated.
X
If desired, activate the Bluetooth connection
between the mobile phone and the audio system* or COMAND APS* (see separate operating instructions).
t
No telephone
Your mobile phone is not inserted in the
bracket*.
X
Insert the mobile phone into the
bracket* (Y page 164).
W
Top up washer fluid Vehicles with bi-xenon headlamps*: The
washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below the minimum.
X
Top up the windscreen washer fluid
(Y page 175).
Z
* optional
221
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 222
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
Points to remember
G Risk of accident and injury
If maintenance work is carried out incorrectly this can jeopardise the operating safety of your vehicle. You risk losing control of your vehicle
and thereby causing an accident. The safety systems may also no longer be able to protect you or others as they are designed to do.
Always have maintenance work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose.
In particular, all work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Warning and indicator lamps in switches and buttons
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
One or all of the indicator lamps
in the seat heating* button are
flashing. The seat heating* has
switched itself off automatically.
The on-board voltage is too low,
because too many consumers are
switched on.
X
Switch off consumers that are not required, e. g. reading lamp or
interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat ventilation* will
switch back on automatically.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The indicator lamp in the 2
Cooling has been deactivated
button on the air-conditioning*/ due to a malfunction.
Thermotronic* control panel
lights up. The cooling system cannot be switched on.
222
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 223
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
The indicator lamp in the F/ The on-board voltage is too low,
1 rear-window heating button because too many consumers are
is flashing. The rear-window heat- switched on.
ing has switched itself off prematurely or cannot be switched on.
Vehicles with automatic child
seat recognition on the frontpassenger seat:
The 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG
OFF warning lamp on the centre
console is lit.
Suggested solutions
X
Switch off consumers that are not required, e. g. reading lamp or
interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window heating
will switch back on automatically.
X
Remove electronic equipment from the front-passenger seat, for
example
Rnotebook
A special Mercedes-Benz child
seat with automatic child seat
recognition has been fitted to the
front-passenger seat. The frontpassenger airbag has therefore
been disabled as desired.
G Risk of injury
There is no child seat fitted to the
front-passenger seat. The automatic child seat recognition is
malfunctioning.
Rmobile
Rcards
phone
with transponders, e.g. ski passes or access passes
If the 5 PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF warning lamp is still lit:
You have started the engine with
the key. The indicator lamp in the
ECO start/stop function* button
does not light up or goes out
again after a short time.
* optional
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
You have deactivated the ECO
start/stop function*.
X
Activate the ECO start/stop function* again.
The ECO start/stop function*is
not available due to a fault.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
223
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 224
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
- The yellow ABS warning
lamp comes on while the
engine is running.
Drive on carefully.
Observe the additional messages in the multi-function display
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) is
(Y page 202).
deactivated due to a fault. ThereX
®
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
fore, ESP (Electronic Stability
Program), BAS (Brake Assist), the
steering assistant STEER CONTROL, the hill start assist and the
tyre pressure loss warning system are also deactivated.
The brake system continues to
function normally, but without
electronic support. The wheels
could therefore lock if you brake
hard.
If the ABS control unit is faulty,
other systems may also not be
available: e.g. Parktronic system*, the navigation system* or
the Autotronic*.
- The yellow ABS warning
lamp comes on while the
engine is running.
224
Suggested solutions
G Risk of accident
X
G Risk of accident
X
The on-board voltage is too low.
ABS has been deactivated due to
undervoltage.
X
Switch off consumers that are not required, e g. reading lamps or
interior lighting.
ABS will be available again as soon as the vehicle's electrical system voltage increases.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 225
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
ESP®,
Therefore,
BAS, the steering assistant STEER CONTROL,
hill start assist and the tyre pressure loss warning system are also
deactivated.
The brake system continues to
function normally, but without
electronic support. The wheels
could therefore lock if you brake
hard.
v The yellow ESP® warning
G Risk of accident
lamp is lit while the engine
ESP® is unavailable due to a malis running. In addition, a
function.
message appears in the
The following systems have also
multi-function display.
been deactivated:
Observe the additional messages in the multi-function display
(Y page 202).
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
RBAS
Rthe
steering assistant STEER
CONTROL
Rhill
start assist
Rthe
tyre pressure loss warning
system
The braking system remains
available with full brake boosting
effect but without the above functions.
Z
225
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 226
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
v The yellow ESP® warning
lamp flashes while the
vehicle is in motion.
Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as necessary when pulling away.
ESP® or traction control has
X Release the accelerator pedal while you are driving.
intervened because there is a risk
of skidding or at least one wheel X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
has started to spin.
G Risk of accident
Suggested solutions
X
1 The red SRS warning lamp G Risk of injury
is lit while the engine is
There is a malfunction in the
running.
restraint system. The airbags or
belt tensioners may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the
event of an accident, not be triggered at all.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
1 The red SRS warning lamp The connector on the removable
is lit while the engine is
front-passenger seat* is
running. In addition, the
detached.
indicator lamp 5
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF
flashes in the centre console and a warning tone
sounds.
X
Attach the connector to the coupling on the seat (Y page 156).
H The red brake system
You are driving with the parking
warning lamp comes on
brake applied.
while you are driving. A
warning tone also sounds.
X
Release the parking brake.
The warning lamp goes out and the warning tone ceases.
226
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 227
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
H The red brake system
warning lamp comes on
while the engine is running.
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions. Do not continue driving under any circumstanThere is insufficient brake fluid in
ces.
the fluid reservoir.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
X Observe the additional messages in the multi-function display
(Y page 202).
Do not top up the brake fluid. This will not rectify the fault.
G Risk of accident
Suggested solutions
X
± The yellow engine diagnos- Vehicles with a diesel engine: the
tics warning lamp lights up fuel tank has been run dry.
while the engine is running.
X
Start the engine three to four times after refuelling.
Emergency running mode is cancelled. The vehicle need not be
checked.
± The yellow engine diagnos- There may be a fault, for example
tics warning lamp lights up Rin the engine management
while the engine is runRin the ignition system
ning.
Rin the exhaust system
X
Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
Rin the
ignition system (for vehicles with petrol engines)
The emission limit values may be
exceeded and the engine can run
in emergency mode.
Z
227
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 228
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
< The red seat belt warning
lamp lights up for 6 seconds after the engine
starts up28.
The seat belt warning lamp
reminds the driver and front
passenger to fasten their seat
belts.
X
Fasten your seat belt (Y page 73).
X
Fasten your seat belt (Y page 73).
The warning tone ceases.
X
Fasten your seat belt (Y page 73).
The warning lamp goes out.
X
Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them
safely.
The warning lamp goes out.
< After the engine starts, a
warning tone sounds for
up to 6 seconds28.
< The red seat belt warning
lamp lights up after the
engine starts, as soon as
the driver's door or the
front-passenger door is
closed.
28 Only
228
for certain countries.
G Risk of injury
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
G Risk of injury
The driver or front passenger has
not fastened their seat belt
G Risk of injury
There are objects on the frontpassenger seat
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 229
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
< The red warning lamp
flashes and an intermittent audible warning
sounds.
Possible cause/consequence
G Risk of injury
Suggested solutions
X
Fasten your seat belt (Y page 73).
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
X
Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow them
safely.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent audible warning
ceases.
X
Refuel at the nearest filling station.
The driver or front passenger has
not fastened their seat belt and
you are driving faster than
25 km/h or have briefly driven
faster than 25 km/h.
G Risk of injury
There are objects on the frontpassenger seat and you are driving faster than 25 km/h or have
briefly driven faster than
25 km/h.
The yellow engine diagnostics
warning lamp lights up while the
engine is running.
The fuel level has fallen below the
reserve range.
Z
229
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 230
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Warning tones
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
The anti-theft warning alarm* is
triggered.
You have opened the vehicle with
the anti-theft alarm system still
activated*.
X
Switch off the alarm (Y page 57).
You hear a warning tone.
A message appears in the multifunction display.
X
See the explanations for the display message (Y page 202).
You are driving with the parking
brake applied.
X
Release the parking brake.
The light is switched on when you X Turn the light switch to M or U.
leave the vehicle.
or
X If the rear foglamp is switched on: press the light switch in to the
stop.
G Risk of injury
X
Fasten your seat belt (Y page 73).
The driver or front passenger has
not fastened their seat belt
230
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 231
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
You hear a warning tone.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*:
You have:
X
Rswitched
Ropened
Move the selector lever to P.
off the engine
the driver's door
Rnot moved the selector lever to
position P
Accident
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Fuel is leaking from the vehicle.
Switch off the ignition immediately.
Remove the ignition key.
The fuel line or the fuel tank has
Do
not restart the engine under any circumstances. The leaking fuel
been damaged. The leaking fuel
creates a risk of fire or explosion. creates a risk of fire or explosion.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
G Risk of fire
Suggested solutions
X
X
You are unable to determine the
extent of the damage.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
You cannot detect any damage.
X
Start the engine as normal.
Z
* optional
231
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 232
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Fuel and fuel tank
Problem
Fuel is leaking from the vehicle.
Possible cause/consequence
G Risk of explosion or fire
The fuel line or the fuel tank is
defective.
The fuel filler flap cannot be
opened.
The fuel tank in a diesel engine
vehicle has been run completely
dry and the engine will not start.
232
The fuel filler flap is not released.
Suggested solutions
Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 62) in the ignition lock immediately and remove it.
X Do not restart the engine under any circumstances.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Unlock the vehicle (Y page 241).
or
X
Unlock the vehicle manually (Y page 242).
The opening mechanism is jammed.
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
There is air in the fuel system.
Refuel the vehicle.
Switch on the ignition for approximately 10 seconds (key in position 2 (Y page 62) in the ignition lock).
X Start the engine continuously for up to 40 seconds until it runs
smoothly.
The fuel system is now free of air.
If the engine does not start:
X Wait two minutes.
X Repeat the starting procedure for up to 40 seconds.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 233
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Engine
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
The engine will not start. You can
hear the starter motor operating.
RThe
X
engine electronics system
is malfunctioning.
Turn the key back to position 0 (Y page 62) in the ignition lock
before the next starting attempt.
X Try to start the engine again (Y page 87). When doing so, remember
RThere is a malfunction in the
that excessively long and frequent attempts to start the engine will
fuel supply.
drain the battery.
RThe on-board voltage is too low
If
the
engine does not start after several attempts:
because the starter battery is
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
too weak or discharged.
The engine will not start. You can The fuel tank has been run dry.
hear the starter motor operating.
The reserve fuel warning lamp is
on and the fuel gauge shows 0.
X
X
Refuel the vehicle.
Bleed the fuel system (Y page 232).
The engine will not start. You can- The on-board voltage is too low X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 266).
not hear the starter motor oper- because the starter battery is too If the engine does not start despite attempting to jump-start it:
ating.
weak or discharged.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The starter motor was exposed to
a thermal load that was too high.
Allow the starter motor to cool down for approximately two
minutes.
X Try to start the engine again.
If the engine still does not start:
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
233
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 234
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
Vehicles with a petrol engine:
The engine is not running
smoothly and is misfiring.
There is a malfunction in the
engine electronics or a mechanical component of the engine control unit.
X
A coolant temperature of over
120 °C is displayed. The coolant
warning lamp may also be on and
a warning tone may sound
(Y page 97).
The coolant level is too low. The
coolant is too hot and the engine
is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X
If the coolant level is correct, the
radiator fan may be faulty. The
coolant is too hot and the engine
is no longer being cooled sufficiently.
X
234
Only depress the accelerator pedal slightly.
X Have the cause rectified immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Otherwise, non-combusted fuel may get into the catalytic converter
and damage it.
Stop as soon as possible and allow the engine and the coolant to
cool down.
X Check the coolant level (Y page 175). Observe the warning notes
as you do so and top up the coolant if necessary.
If the coolant temperature is less than 120 °C, you can continue
driving to the nearest qualified specialist workshop.
X Avoid heavy loads on the engine as you do so, e.g. driving on
mountain roads and stop/start driving.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 235
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
AUTOTRONIC*
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
The transmission has problems
shifting gear
The transmission is losing oil.
X
The acceleration ability is deteri- The transmission is in emergency
orating.
mode.
The one-touch gearshifting is no
longer working.
The transmission no longer
changes gear.
Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
Stop the vehicle.
Move the selector lever to position P.
X Turn the key to position 0 in the ignition lock.
X Wait at least 10 seconds before restarting the engine.
X Move the selector lever to position D or R.
X Have the transmission checked at a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
X
X
Z
* optional
235
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 236
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Parktronic*
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
Only the red segments in the
Parktronic has malfunctioned
Parktronic warning display are lit. and has switched itself off.
You also hear a warning tone for
approximately two seconds.
Parktronic is deactivated after
approximately 20 seconds and
the indicator lamp in the Parktronic button lights up.
X
If problems persist, have Parktronic checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Only the red segments in the
The Parktronic sensors are dirty
Parktronic warning display are lit. or there is interference.
Parktronic is deactivated after
approximately 20 seconds.
X
X
Clean the Parktronic sensors (Y page 196).
Switch the ignition back on.
Only the red segments in the
The problem may be caused by an
Parktronic warning display are lit. external source of radio or ultraParktronic is deactivated after
sound waves.
approximately 20 seconds.
X
See if Parktronic functions in a different location.
236
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 237
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Headlamps
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
The headlamps or the turn signals Air humidity is very high.
in the exterior mirrors are misted
up on the inside.
The headlamp housing is not
sealed and moisture has been
able to enter.
Suggested solutions
X
Drive with the headlamps switched on.
The headlamps are demisted after a short distance.
X
Have the headlamps checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Windscreen wipers
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
The windscreen wipers are jammed.
Leaves or snow, for example, may
be obstructing the windscreen
wiper movement. The wiper
motor has been deactivated.
X
The windscreen wipers fail completely.
G Risk of accident
The windscreen wiper drive is
malfunctioning.
For safety reasons, you should remove the key from the ignition
lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windscreen wipers back on.
X
X
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
Have the windscreen wipers checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
237
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 238
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Side windows
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
A side window will not close.
Objects are trapped between the
window and the door frame.
X
There are objects in the window
guide rail which are preventing
the window from closing.
X
You cannot see the cause.
X
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
X
X
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
Remove the objects.
Close the side window.
Close the side window with increased force or without the antientrapment feature (Y page 85).
Mirrors
Problem
An exterior mirror has been
pushed out of position.
Vehicles with exterior mirrors that cannot be folded in/out electrically:
X Move the exterior mirror into the correct position manually.
Vehicles with electrically folding exterior mirrors*:
X
238
Press the mirror-folding button* (Y page 71) repeatedly until you
hear a distinct click.
The mirror housing is engaged again and you can adjust the mirror
as usual (Y page 71).
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 239
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Key
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
Suggested solutions
You cannot lock or unlock the
vehicle using the key.
The key batteries are discharged
or nearly discharged.
X
The key is faulty.
X
Point the tip of the key at the driver's door handle from close range
and try to unlock or lock the vehicle again.
If this does not work:
X Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 241).
X Check the key batteries (Y page 244) and replace them if necessary (Y page 244).
Unlock the vehicle using the emergency key element
(Y page 241).
X Have the key checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
The battery charge indicator lamp The key batteries are discharged.
of the key does not go on during
the test.
X
You have lost a key.
X
Change the batteries (Y page 244).
Have the key cancelled at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the manual locks changed too.
X
You have lost the emergency key
element.
The engine cannot be started
using the key.
X
X
The steering lock is mechanically
blocked.
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
If necessary, have the manual locks changed too.
Remove the key and reinsert it into the ignition lock. While doing
this, turn the steering wheel in both directions.
239
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 240
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Troubleshooting
Trailer towing
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
The ball coupling cannot be
G Risk of accident
locked.
The ball coupling is dirty.
The key cannot be removed from
The trailer tow hitch is damaged.
the ball coupling.
Suggested solutions
Remove the ball coupling and clean it (Y page 196). If the ball coupling still cannot be locked, remove the ball coupling. It must no
longer be used to tow a trailer, as safe operation is not guaranteed.
X Have the entire trailer tow hitch checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
X
Parking up the vehicle
Problem
Possible cause/consequence
The vehicle is to be left parked up Damage resulting from non-use
for longer than six weeks.
may occur if the vehicle is parked
up for long periods.
240
Suggested solutions
X
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and seek advice.
Disconnect the battery (Y page 265).
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 241
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Locking/unlocking in an emergency
Locking/unlocking in an emergency
Emergency key
If the vehicle can no longer be locked or
unlocked with the key, use the emergency
key element.
If you use the emergency key element to
unlock and open the driver's door, the antitheft alarm system* will be triggered
(Y page 57).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X Press the k or j button on the key.
or
X Insert the key into the ignition lock.
If you unlock the vehicle using the emergency
key element, the fuel filler flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the fuel filler flap: insert the
key in the ignition lock.
Releasing and removing the emergency
key element
X
Unlocking the vehicle
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked centrally with the key:
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 241).
Push release catch 1 in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time remove
emergency key element 2 from the key.
$ To unlock
Insert the emergency key element into the
lock of the driver's door as far as it will go.
X Firmly turn the emergency key element
anti-clockwise as far as it will go to position
$ and hold it in this position.
X
i On right-hand-drive vehicles, turn the
emergency key element clockwise.
X
* optional
Pull the door handle firmly.
The locking knob pops up.
The door is unlocked.
Z
241
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 242
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Locking/unlocking in an emergency
Turn the emergency key element back and
remove it.
X Pull the door handle again.
X
Locking the vehicle
If the vehicle can no longer be locked centrally with the key:
5-door
Close the front-passenger door, the rear
door on the front-passenger side and the
tailgate.
X Open the driver’s door and the rear door on
the driver’s side.
X Press the locking button on the driver’s
door (Y page 61).
The locking knobs in the front-passenger
door and in the rear doors drop down.
X Press the locking knobs in the frontpassenger and rear doors down manually,
if necessary.
X Close the driver's door from the outside.
X Press down the locking knob in the driver's
door by reaching through the open rear
door.
X
242
i Make sure that you have the key with you
and have not left it in the vehicle.
X
Close the rear door on the driver’s side.
The vehicle is locked.
3-door
Close the front-passenger door.
Open the driver's door and the tailgate.
X Press the locking button on the driver’s
door (Y page 61).
The locking knob in the front-passenger
door moves down.
X Press down the locking knob manually, if
necessary.
X Close the driver's door from the outside.
X Press down the locking knob in the driver's
door by reaching through the open tailgate.
X
X
Emergency fuel filler flap release
G Risk of injury
The corners of the vehicle walls may be
sharp-edged. You could injure yourself
while carrying out an emergency release of
the fuel filler flap. Avoid contact with the
edges of the vehicle walls.
The emergency release is located on the
right-hand side of the luggage compartment,
behind the side trim panel when viewed in the
direction of travel.
X Open the tailgate.
X Open the cover on the right-hand side of
the luggage compartment (Y page 161).
i Make sure that you have the key with you
and have not left it in the vehicle.
X
Close the tailgate.
The vehicle is locked.
1 Emergency release
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 243
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Locking/unlocking in an emergency
Pull emergency release 1 in the direction
of the arrow.
The fuel filler flap is unlocked.
X Open the fuel filler flap.
X
Vehicles with the CLASSIC or AVANTGARDE*design/trim level
Vehicles with the ELEGANCE*design/
trim level or with the optional front
compartment armrest*
Releasing the parking lock manually
on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
In the event of an electrical fault, it is possible
to release the selector lever lock manually to
move it out of position P, e.g. if you wish to
tow the vehicle away.
Releasing the parking lock manually
1 Screwdriver or similar implement
Insert implement 1 into the opening.
Push implement 1 in the direction of the
arrow and simultaneously move the selector lever out of position P.
X Remove implement 1.
The selector lever can now be moved freely
until it is returned to position P.
X
X
1 Cup holder
Apply the parking brake.
X Pull up cup holder 1.
X
* optional
Releasing the parking lock manually
1 Screwdriver or similar implement
2 Release pin
G Risk of injury
Release pin 2 can become very hot. Therefore only press the release pin with a suitable screwdriver or similar implement; otherwise, you could burn yourself.
X
Use implement 1 to press release pin 2
and simultaneously move the selector lever
out of position P.
The selector lever can now be moved freely
until it is returned to position P.
243
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 244
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the batteries
Changing the batteries
Notes
It is advisable to have the batteries replaced
at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. at a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of poisoning
Batteries contain toxic and caustic substances. For this reason, keep batteries
away from children.
If a battery is swallowed, consult a doctor
immediately.
Key
Checking the batteries
X
Press the j or k button.
The batteries are in order if the battery
charge indicator lamp lights up briefly.
Using emergency key element 1, press
the grey release catch in the opening in the
direction of arrow 2.
Battery tray 4 is released.
X Pull battery tray 4 out of the key in the
direction of arrow 3.
X
Changing the batteries
You require two CR 2025 3 V cell batteries.
X Remove the emergency key element from
the key (Y page 241).
H Environmental note
Do not dispose of batteries with the household rubbish, as they contain highly toxic
substances.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre, or to a special collection
point for old batteries.
1 Emergency key element
2 To release the battery tray
3 To pull out the battery tray
4 Battery tray
244
Remove old batteries 1 from the battery
tray.
X Insert the new batteries underneath contact spring 2 with the positive terminal
facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth to do
so.
X Push the battery tray back into the key
housing until the battery tray engages.
X Check the function of all key buttons on the
vehicle.
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 245
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
Changing the bulbs
Notes on changing bulbs
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
G Risk of injury
Bulbs and lamps can be very hot. You
should therefore allow them to cool down
before you change them. Otherwise, you
could be burned if you touch them.
Keep bulbs out of the reach of children.
Otherwise, they could damage them, for
example, and injure themselves.
Never use a bulb which has been dropped.
Such a bulb may explode and injure you.
H7 bulbs are pressurised and could explode
when you change them, particularly if they
are very hot. You should therefore wear eye
protection and gloves when you are changing them.
contacts on xenon bulbs. Therefore, never
remove the cover from xenon bulbs.
Do not change xenon bulbs yourself, but
have them replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the
work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to
safety or on safety-related systems must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Overview
G Risk of injury
Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You could
get an electric shock and be seriously or
even fatally injured if you touch the electric
Z
245
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 246
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
Front bulbs
Rear bulbs
Bulb
Type
Additional turn
signal lamp
LEDs29
2
Parking lamp/
side lamp
W5W
3
Main-beam
headlamps30/
cornering
light*31
H7 55 W
Dipped-beam
headlamps
H7 55 W30
or
D1S 35 W*32
1
4
RSide
Bulb
Type
Third brake
lamp
LED29
8
Licence plate
lamp
C5W
9
Rear foglamp
P 21 W
Tail lamp
P4W
7
a
Turn signal lamp PY 21 W
b
Reversing lamp
P 21 W
c
Brake lamp
P 21 W
5
Turn signal lamp PY 21 W
Before changing bulbs
6
Front foglamps* H11 55 W33
You can replace the following bulbs:
RDipped-beam
lamps)
RMain-beam
lamps)
headlamps (halogen head-
headlamps (halogen head-
lamp/parking lamp (halogen headlamps)
RCornering
light* (vehicles with bi-xenon
headlamps*)
RFront
turn signal lamp
RBrake
lamp
RReversing
lamp
RRear
foglamp/tail lamp
RTurn
signal lamp (rear)
RLicence
plate lamp
Observe the following points:
RUse
only the bulb types specified here.
RTo
prevent a short-circuit, switch off the
lights before changing a bulb.
ROnly hold bulbs with a clean, lint-free cloth.
RDo
not work with wet or greasy fingers.
RIf
the new bulb still does not light up, consult a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
29 LEDs
must not be replaced, as they are designed to have an unlimited service life.
with halogen headlamps.
31 Vehicles with bi-xenon headlamps*
32 Vehicles with xenon headlamps*: always have these bulbs changed at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
33 These bulbs must be replaced at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
30 Vehicles
246
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 247
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
i Due to the location of the bulbs in the
front headlamps, it is best to have these
changed at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
i Have the headlamp setting checked regularly at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Changing the front bulbs
X
X
To close: fold the cover upwards.
Screw in retaining screw 1.
Removing/fitting the washer fluid reservoir
You must remove the washer fluid reservoir
from the engine compartment before you can
replace the bulbs in the front left-hand headlamp.
To fit: guide the lower retaining lug into the
rubber grommet on the longitudinal member and fit washer fluid reservoir 2 into
bracket 3.
X Turn retaining screw 1 clockwise.
X
Replacing the bulbs in the dipped-beam
headlamp (halogen headlamps)
Opening/closing the cover in the front
wheel arch
Switch off the lights.
Open the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 247).
X Open the bonnet.
X Left-hand headlamps: remove the washer
fluid reservoir (Y page 247).
X Press retaining lug : down and remove
housing cover 2.
X Pull connector = from bulb holder 4.
X
To remove: turn retaining screw 1 anticlockwise.
X Remove washer fluid reservoir 2 from
bracket 3.
X Put washer fluid reservoir 2 to one side
and leave the lines and hoses connected.
Make sure that no washer fluid escapes.
X
To open: turn the front wheels inwards.
Unscrew retaining screw 1.
X Fold the cover down.
X
X
X
247
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 248
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
Turn bulb holder 4 anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Remove the bulb from bulb holder 4.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder 4.
X Insert bulb holder 4 and turn it clockwise.
X Attach connector = to bulb holder 4.
X Align the bottom of housing cover 2 and
fold it upwards until it engages.
X
Main-beam headlamps (halogen headlamps)/cornering light*(bi-xenon headlamps*)
Remove the washer fluid reservoir
(Y page 247).
X Press retaining lug 1 down and remove
housing cover ;.
X Main-beam headlamps: pull connector =
from the bulb.
X Turn housing cover ? anti-clockwise.
X Remove the bulb.
X Insert the new bulb so that it is flush.
X Turn housing cover ? clockwise.
X Main-beam headlamps: attach connector = to the bulb.
X Align the bottom of housing cover ; and
fold it upwards until it engages.
X
Replacing the bulb in the side lamp/
parking lamp (halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 247).
X Open the bonnet.
X Remove the washer fluid reservoir
(Y page 247).
X Press retaining lug : down and remove
housing cover ;.
X Pull out bulb holder =.
X Turn the bulb anti-clockwise, applying
slight pressure, and remove it from bulb
holder =.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder = and
turn it clockwise.
X Insert bulb holder =.
X Align the bottom of housing cover ; and
fold it upwards until it engages.
X
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 247).
X Open the bonnet.
X
X
248
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 249
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
Replacing the turn signal lamps
Insert the new bulb into bulb holder : and
turn clockwise while applying slight pressure.
X Insert bulb holder : and turn it clockwise.
X
Changing the rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
Switch off the lights.
X Open the cover in the front wheel arch
(Y page 247).
X Open the bonnet.
X Left-hand headlamp: remove the washer
fluid reservoir (Y page 247).
X Turn bulb holder : anti-clockwise and pull
it out.
X Turn the bulb anti-clockwise, applying
slight pressure, and remove it from bulb
holder :.
X
You must open the side trim panel in the luggage compartment before you can change
the bulbs in the tail lamps.
Left-hand side trim panel
Right-hand side trim panel
Opening
X Turn release catch 1 90° in the direction
of the arrow and remove side trim panel
2.
X Left side: remove the compressor.
X Right side: remove the stowage compartment.
Closing
X Left side: insert the compressor.
X Right side: insert the stowage compartment.
X Insert side trim panel 2 and turn catch
1 90° in the opposite direction to the
arrow.
249
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 250
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Changing the bulbs
Changing the tail lamps
Changing the bulbs in the licence plate
lamps
Switch off the lights.
Open the luggage compartment.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 249).
X
X
Bulb holder
1 Brake lamp
2 Reversing lamp
3 Turn signal lamp
Bulb holder
X
Press retaining lugs 1 simultaneously in
the direction of the arrow and pull the bulb
holder out.
250
4 Rear foglamp/tail lamp
Lightly press the corresponding bulb into
the holder, turn it anti-clockwise and
remove it from the bulb holder.
X Insert the corresponding new bulb into the
bulb holder and turn it clockwise.
X Attach the bulb holder and press firmly.
The retaining lugs on the bulb holder
engages audibly.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 249).
X
Switch off the lights.
Open the tailgate.
X Using a screwdriver, loosen both sides of
licence plate lamp 1 in the direction of the
arrow.
X Remove licence plate lamp 1.
X Replace the bulb.
X Insert licence plate lamp 1 and press it in
until it engages.
X
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 251
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Replacing the wiper blades
Position the new wiper blade 1 with
recess 6 on lug 5.
X Fold wiper blade 1 in the direction of
arrow 3 onto the wiper arm, until retaining
clips 2 engage in bracket 4.
X Make sure that wiper blade 1 is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windscreen.
Replacing the wiper blades
X
Windscreen wiper blades
G Risk of accident
The windscreen will not longer be properly
wiped if the wiper blades are worn. This
could prevent you from observing the traffic
conditions, thereby causing an accident.
Replace the wiper blades twice a year, ideally in spring and autumn.
G Risk of accident
The wiper arms could start moving and
cause an injury if you leave the windscreen
wipers switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock
before replacing the wiper blades.
! Make sure that you touch only the wiper
Press both release clips 2.
Fold wiper blade 1 in the direction of
arrow 3 away from wiper arm 4.
X Remove wiper blade 1 in the direction of
the arrow 5.
X
X
Fitting
Rear window wiper blade
G Risk of injury
The wiper arm could be set in motion and
injure you if the windscreen wipers are
switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock
before replacing the wiper blade.
arm of the windscreen wiper to avoid damaging the windscreen wiper blades.
Removing
X
X
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Fold the wiper arm away from the windscreen.
Z
251
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 252
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Replacing the wiper blades
Removing
Turn wiper blade 1 parallel to the wiper
arm.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the rear window.
X
Adjusting the spraying nozzles
Check the spraying nozzles setting regularly.
If they have moved, you can readjust them
yourself.
G Risk of injury
Remove the key from the ignition lock.
Fold the wiper arm away from the rear window until it engages.
X Turn wiper blade 1 in the direction of
arrow 2 until it is released from the
retainer on the wiper arm.
X Remove wiper blade 1.
X
X
Fitting
Push the new wiper blade 1 onto the wiper
arm until you feel it engage.
X Make sure that wiper blade 1 is seated
correctly.
X
252
The wiper arms could start moving and
cause an injury if you leave the windscreen
wipers switched on.
Remove the key from the ignition lock
before adjusting the spraying nozzles.
! Do not use any tools, e.g. a needle, to
adjust the spraying nozzles. There is otherwise a risk of damaging the spraying nozzles.
Swivel spraying nozzles 1 upwards or
downwards.
X Wipe briefly with washer fluid to test them
(Y page 83).
The spraying nozzles are correctly positioned if the stream of water hits the windscreen approximately in the centre.
X
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 253
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Flat tyre
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
Flat tyre equipment variants
X
Your vehicle may be equipped with:
Ra TIREFIT kit (Y page 200)
Ra
"Minispare" emergency spare
wheel* (Y page 201)
Ra
spare wheel* (Y page 201)
Rthe
MOExtended run-flat system* (Y page 262)
Preparing the vehicle
i Vehicle preparation is not necessary on
vehicles with MOE tyres*.
Stop your vehicle as far away from traffic
as possible on solid, non-slippery, level
ground.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Apply the handbrake.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission
X
Shift to either first or reverse gear.
Move the selector lever to P.
For all vehicles
All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area whilst a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Switch off the engine.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
Get out of the vehicle.
X Close the driver’s door.
X Place the warning triangle (Y page 200) at
a suitable distance. Observe legal requirements.
X
Using the TIREFIT kit
You can use the TIREFIT kit to seal small
punctures, particularly those in the tyre tread.
You can use TIREFIT in outdoor temperatures
down to -20 °C.
G Risk of accident
In the following situations, your safety is at
particular risk and tyre sealant is unable to
provide breakdown assistance:
Rif there are cuts or punctures in the tyre
greater than 4 mm
Rif
the wheel rim is damaged
Rif
you have driven at very low tyre pressures or on a flat tyre
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to
safety or on safety-related systems must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
* optional
253
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 254
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tyre, e.g. screws or
nails.
X Remove TIREFIT, the accompanying "max.
80 km/h" sticker and the electric air pump
from the stowage compartment
(Y page 200).
X
RIf
TIREFIT comes into contact with your
eyes or skin, immediately rinse thoroughly with clean water.
RChange
out of clothing which has come
into contact with TIREFIT immediately.
RIf
an allergic reaction occurs, consult a
doctor immediately.
Keep TIREFIT away from children.
RIf TIREFIT is swallowed, immediately
rinse your mouth out thoroughly with
water and drink plenty of water.
i Your vehicle may be equipped with one of
two different air pumps. Version 1 can be
identified by the flap, behind which the
hose with the pressure gauge and cable are
located; version 2 has a pressure gauge
integrated in the electric air pump.
Type 1
RDo not induce vomiting. Consult a doctor
immediately.
RDo
1 Driver's field of vision sticker
2 Wheel sticker
Affix part 1 of the sticker within the driver's field of vision.
X Affix part 2 of the sticker near the valve
on the wheel with the defective tyre.
X
G Risk of injury
TIREFIT must not come into contact with
your skin, eyes or clothing.
254
not inhale TIREFIT fumes.
i If TIREFIT leaks out, allow it to dry. It can
then be removed like a layer of film.
If you get TIREFIT on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethylene.
1 TIREFIT sealant filler bottle
2 Flap
G Risk of injury
3 Recess
4 On/off switch
Comply with the manufacturer's safety
instructions shown on the sticker on the
electric air pump.
7 Flange
5 Electric connector with cable
6 Air pump hose
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 255
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Do not switch off the electric pump during this phase.
X Let the electric pump run for five minutes.
The tyre should then have a pressure of at
least 1.8 bar.
Open flap 2 on the electric air pump.
Pull connector 5 and air pump hose 6
from the housing.
X Screw air pump hose 6 onto flange 7 of
TIREFIT filler bottle 1.
X Place TIREFIT sealant filler bottle 1 head
downwards into recess 3 of the electric
air pump.
X
X
! Do not operate the electric air pump for
a Pressure release screw
b Pressure gauge
Make sure pressure release screw a on
pressure gauge b is fully closed.
X Screw filler hose 8 onto valve 9.
X
Insert plug 5 into the socket of the cigarette lighter* (Y page 163) or into a 12 V
power socket in your vehicle .
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X
8 Filler hose
9 Valve
X
Remove the cap from valve 9 on the faulty
tyre.
X
Press on/off switch 4 on the electric air
pump to I.
The electric air pump is switched on. The
tyre is inflated.
i First, TIREFIT is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure can briefly rise to around 5 bar.
* optional
longer than eight minutes at a time without
a break. Otherwise, it may overheat.
The air pump can be operated again once
it has cooled down.
If a pressure of 1.8 bar is not reached after
five minutes:
Switch off and disconnect the electric air
pump and drive the vehicle forwards or
backwards approximately 10 m.
This distributes the TIREFIT more evenly.
X Remove TIREFIT sealant filler bottle 1
from the electric pump.
X Pump up the tyre again.
X
G Risk of accident
If a pressure of 1.8 bar is not achieved after
five minutes, the tyre is too badly damaged.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. Mercedes-Benz rec-
255
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 256
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
ommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 1.8 bar is reached:
Press on/off switch 4 on the electric air
pump to 0.
The electric air pump is switched off.
X Disconnect the electric air pump and stow
it away.
X Fold up the warning triangle and stow it
away.
X Pull away immediately.
This distributes the TIREFIT more evenly
around the tyre.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the electric air pump.
X
G Risk of accident
If the tyre pressure is now lower than
1.3 bar, the tyre is too badly damaged. Do
not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
256
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
If the tyre pressure is still at least 1.3 bar,
correct it (see fuel filler flap for values).
To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the electric air pump.
To reduce the tyre pressure: open pressure release screw a on pressure
gauge b.
X Drive to the nearest workshop and have the
tyre changed there.
X Have the TIREFIT kit replaced as soon as
possible at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X
H Environmental note
Have the used TIREFIT kit disposed of professionally, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X
Have the TIREFIT kit replaced every four
years at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Type 2
G Risk of accident
Do not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
The "max. 80 km/h" sticker must be affixed
within the driver's field of vision.
The vehicle's handling characteristics may
be affected.
1 TIREFIT sealant filler bottle
2 Recess
3 On/off switch
4 Electric connector with cable
5 Air pump hose
6 Flange
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 257
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Pull connector 4 and air pump hose 5
from the housing.
X Screw air pump hose 5 onto flange 6 of
TIREFIT filler bottle 1.
X Place TIREFIT sealant filler bottle 1 head
downwards into recess 2 of the electric
air pump.
X
Insert plug 4 into the socket of the cigarette lighter* (Y page 163) or into a 12 V
power socket in your vehicle .
X Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X
X
Press on/off switch 3 on the electric air
pump to I.
The electric air pump is switched on. The
tyre is inflated.
i First, TIREFIT is pumped into the tyre. The
pressure can briefly rise to around 5 bar.
Do not switch off the electric pump during this phase.
X
7 Valve
8 Filler hose
Remove the cap from valve 7 on the faulty
tyre.
X Screw filler hose 8 onto valve 7.
X
* optional
Let the electric pump run for five minutes.
The tyre should then have a pressure of at
least 1.8 bar.
! Do not operate the electric air pump for
longer than eight minutes at a time without
a break. Otherwise, it may overheat.
The air pump can be operated again once
it has cooled down.
If a pressure of 1.8 bar is not reached after
five minutes:
Switch off and disconnect the electric air
pump and drive the vehicle forwards or
backwards approximately 10 m.
This distributes the TIREFIT more evenly.
X Remove TIREFIT sealant filler bottle 1
from the electric pump.
X Pump up the tyre again.
X
G Risk of accident
If a pressure of 1.8 bar is not achieved after
five minutes, the tyre is too badly damaged.
Do not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
If a tyre pressure of 1.8 bar is reached:
Press on/off switch 3 on the electric air
pump to 0.
The electric air pump is switched off.
X Disconnect the electric air pump and stow
it away.
X
257
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 258
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Fold up the warning triangle and stow it
away.
X Pull away immediately.
This distributes the TIREFIT more evenly
around the tyre.
X Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tyre pressure with
the electric air pump.
G Risk of accident
X
Do not exceed the maximum speed of
80 km/h.
The "max. 80 km/h" sticker must be affixed
within the driver's field of vision.
The vehicle's handling characteristics may
be affected.
H Environmental note
G Risk of accident
If the tyre pressure is now lower than
1.3 bar, the tyre is too badly damaged. Do
not drive any further. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry
out the work required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safetyrelated systems must be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
258
9 Pressure release button
a Pressure gauge
If the tyre pressure is still at least 1.3 bar,
correct it (see fuel filler flap for values).
To increase the tyre pressure: switch on
the electric air pump.
To reduce the tyre pressure: press yellow
pressure release button 9 next to pressure gauge a.
X Drive to the nearest workshop and have the
tyre changed there.
X Have the TIREFIT kit replaced as soon as
possible at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
X
Have the used TIREFIT kit disposed of professionally, e.g. at a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X
Have the TIREFIT kit replaced every four
years at a qualified specialist workshop,
e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 259
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Changing a wheel/fitting the spare
wheel*
G Risk of accident
The wheel dimensions and tyre size of the
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel* may
differ from those of the standard wheels.
Your vehicle's handling characteristics will
change when a "Minispare" emergency
spare wheel* is fitted. Adapt your style of
driving accordingly.
The "Minispare" emergency spare wheel*
may only be used for a short time. Do not
exceed the maximum speed of 80 km/h
and do not deactivate ESP®.
Never drive the vehicle with more than one
"Minispare" emergency spare wheel* fitted.
G Risk of accident
Have the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel* or the spare wheel* replaced with
a new wheel as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to
carry out the work required. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this pur* optional
pose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
On downhill gradients: place chocks or
similar behind both wheels of the other
axle.
Preparing the vehicle
Prepare the vehicle as described
(Y page 253).
X If a trailer is coupled, uncouple it.
X Place the wheels in the straight-ahead position.
X Take the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel* or the spare wheel* out of the stowage well under the luggage compartment
floor.
X Take the following out of the left-hand
stowage compartment in the luggage compartment
Rthe vehicle tool kit
X
X
Rthe
wheel chock
Rthe
jack
Steel wheel with wheel trim
X
Vehicles with steel wheels: carefully
reach into two wheel trim openings and
remove the wheel trim.
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
On level ground: place chocks or similar
items under the front and rear of the wheel
that is diagonally opposite the wheel you
wish to change.
Z
259
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 260
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
1 Wheel wrench
X
Using wheel wrench 1, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Raising the vehicle
G Risk of injury
The jack is designed only to raise the vehicle for a short time while a wheel is being
changed.
The vehicle must be placed on stands if you
intend to work under it.
Make sure that the jack is placed on a firm,
non-slip, level surface. Do not use wooden
blocks or similar objects as a jack underlay.
260
Otherwise, the jack will not be able to achieve its load-bearing capacity due to the
restricted height.
Do not start the engine at any time while
the wheel is being changed.
Do not lie under the vehicle when it is being
supported by the jack. If you do not raise
the vehicle as described, it could slip off the
jack (e.g. if the engine is started or a door
or the tailgate is opened or closed) and you
could be seriously injured.
G Risk of accident
If you fail to position the jack correctly, the
vehicle may:
Rslip off the jack
Rinjure
Rbe
you or others
damaged
Thus, it is important to make sure that the
jack is positioned correctly in the respective jacking points. Before positioning the
jack, remove any dirt that may have collected in the jacking points.
The jacking points for the jack are located
behind the wheel housings of the front wheels
and in front of the wheel housings of the rear
wheels.
1 Jacking point
2 Jack
3 Ratchet ring spanner with socket wrench
X
Position jack 2 at jacking point 1.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 261
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Make sure that the base of the jack is positioned directly under jacking point 1.
X Take ratchet ring spanner and socket 3
out of the vehicle tool kit.
X Take ratchet ring spanner 3 out of the
vehicle tool kit and place it on the jack so
that the lettering AUF is visible.
X Raise the vehicle with ratchet ring spanner
3 until the tyre is at most three centimetres off the ground.
X
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on a
dirty surface. This could cause damage to
the bolt and wheel hub threads.
X
Remove the wheel.
Fitting a new wheel
G Risk of accident
Replace damaged or corroded wheel bolts.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts.
necessary specialist knowledge and tools
to carry out the work required. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre or Service
24h for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety or on safety-related systems
must be carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
G Risk of accident
Only use wheel bolts that have been
designed for the wheel and the vehicle. For
safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use wheel bolts which
have been approved for Mercedes-Benz
vehicles. Other bolts could work loose.
Do not tighten the wheel bolts completely
while the vehicle is still jacked up. The vehicle could topple off the jack.
X
X
Place the "Minispare" emergency spare
wheel* or the spare wheel onto the wheel
hub and push it on.
X
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
G Risk of accident
If a wheel hub thread is damaged, you must
not drive the vehicle any further. Consult a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
* optional
Z
261
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 262
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Flat tyre
Lowering the vehicle
Place the ratchet ring spanner onto the
hexagon nut of the jack so that the lettering
AB is visible.
X Lower the vehicle by turning the ratchet
ring spanner until the vehicle is once again
standing firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
could work loose if they are not tightened
to a torque of 130 Nm.
X
Turn the jack back to its initial position and
store it and the rest of the vehicle tool kit
in the stowage compartment in the luggage
compartment.
i When you are driving with the "Minispare"
emergency spare wheel* fitted, the tyre
pressure loss warning system* cannot
function reliably.
MOExtended run-flat system*
The MOExtended run-flat system may only be
used in conjunction with the tyre pressure
loss warning system.
! The maximum permissible distance which
1 – 5 Wheel bolts
X
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (1 to 5). The tightening torque is
130 Nm.
G Risk of accident
Have the tightening torque checked immediately after a wheel is changed. The wheels
262
can be driven in run-flat mode depends on
the load in the vehicle. It is 50 km if the
vehicle is partially laden and 30 km if fully
laden.
The maximum range that can be driven in
emergency operation is measured from the
point at which the pressure loss warning
message appears in the multi-function display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
80 km/h.
G Risk of accident
The handling characteristics of your vehicle
deteriorate in run-flat mode, for example:
Rwhen cornering
Rwhen
braking
Rwhen
accelerating rapidly
Adapt your driving style accordingly and
avoid sudden changes in direction and sudden acceleration, as well as driving over
obstacles (i.e. kerbs, potholes), and driving
off-road. This is particularly the case when
the vehicle is heavily laden.
The maximum permissible distance that
can be driven in run-flat mode depends to
a large extent on the loads placed on the
vehicle. It can be shorter due to high
speeds, a heavy load, sudden acceleration
and/or manoeuvring, the road surface condition, outside temperature, etc., or further,
if you drive carefully and conservatively.
Do not continue to drive in run-flat mode if:
Ryou hear banging noises.
Rthe
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou
see smoke and smell rubber.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 263
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Battery
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
Battery
Rthere
are tears in the sidewalls of the
Notes on the vehicle battery
tyre.
After driving in run-flat mode, you must
have the wheel(s) checked for damage at a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools
to carry out the work required. The faulty
tyre must be replaced in every case.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this
purpose. In particular, work relevant to
safety or on safety-related systems must be
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
i On a vehicle with MOExtended tyres, only
use MOExtended spare tyres. These must
be of the size specified for the vehicle.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Have the battery charge checked more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly for short
trips or if you leave it standing idle for a
lengthy period.
To prevent damage from corrosion, only
replace the battery with one that has a central
ventilation cover.
Consult a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre if
you wish to leave your vehicle parked up for
a long period of time.
G Risk of injury
Comply with safety precautions and take
protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, naked flames and
smoking are prohibited
when handling the bat-
tery. Avoid creating
sparks.
Battery acid is caustic.
Avoid contact with the
skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular
gloves, an apron and a
face mask.
Immediately rinse acid
splashes off with clean
water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Owner's
Manual.
H Environmental note
Do not dispose of batteries with the household rubbish. Dispose of defective batteries
in an environmentally responsible manner.
263
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 264
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Battery
Take them to a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre or to a special collection point for
old batteries.
G Risk of injury
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which
have been tested and approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. These batteries
provide increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid
burns should the battery be damaged in the
event of an accident.
To prevent acid burns, observe the following safety notes when handling batteries:
RDo not lean over batteries.
RDo
not place any metal objects on a battery. You could otherwise cause a short
circuit and the battery's gas mixture
could ignite.
RMake sure that you do not create an elec-
trostatic charge, e.g. by wearing synthetic clothing or as a result of friction on
fabrics. Therefore, you should not pull or
slide the battery over carpets or other
synthetic materials.
step out of the vehicle first and touch the
bodywork.
RDo not wipe the battery using a cloth. The
battery could be destroyed as a result of
electrostatic charge or due to flying
sparks.
! Switch off the engine and remove the key
before disconnecting or removing the terminal clamps from the battery. You may
otherwise destroy electronic components,
such as the alternator.
i Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
have all work involving the battery, e.g.
removing, charging and replacing, carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
1 Retaining screw
2 Cap
Remove the floormat*.
Remove retaining screw 1 by turning it
anti-clockwise, e.g. by using a coin.
X Lift up cover 2.
X
X
Installation location of the battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a battery in the
footwell in front of the front-passenger seat.
The main fuse box is also located there.
RNever
touch the battery first. To discharge a possible electrostatic charge,
264
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 265
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Battery
! Always disconnect the battery in the
order described below. Never swap the terminal clamps. You may otherwise damage
the vehicle electronics.
Apply the handbrake and shift the selector
lever to position P on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Turn the key to position 0 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock and remove it.
X Remove the negative terminal clamp from
the battery.
X Remove the cover from the positive terminal clamp.
X Remove the positive terminal clamp from
the battery.
X Disconnect the breather hose.
X
3 Negative terminal
4 Positive terminal
Disconnecting the battery
G Risk of accident
If the battery is disconnected:
Rthe brake boosting effect will not be available. Greater braking force will then be
required and the brake pedal travel will
be longer. If necessary, depress the
brake pedal with maximum force.
Ryou
will no longer be able to turn the key
in the ignition lock.
Rthe
selector lever is locked in position P
on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*.
* optional
Removing the battery
Disconnect the battery (Y page 265).
Loosen the bolt which holds the battery in
place.
X Remove the battery.
X
X
Charging and fitting the battery
G Risk of injury
Only charge the battery in a well-ventilated
area. As the battery is being charged, gases
can escape and generate minor explosions.
This may injure you and other persons or
cause damage to the paintwork or acid corrosion on the vehicle.
You can obtain information about battery
chargers which allow the battery to be
charged when still installed from a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of acid burns during the
charging process due to the gases which
escape from the battery. Do not lean over
the battery during the charging process.
Z
265
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 266
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Jump-starting
G Risk of injury
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with
the skin, eyes or clothing.
Reconnecting the battery
! Always reconnect the battery in the
sequence described below. Never swap the
terminal clamps. You may otherwise damage the vehicle electronics.
! Only charge the installed battery with a
battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. These battery
chargers allow the battery to be charged
while it is still installed. However, the battery must always be disconnected first.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
Charge the battery. Observe the notes in
the operating instructions for your battery
charger.
X Refit the charged battery.
To do this, follow the steps described in
"Removing the battery" (Y page 265) in
reverse order.
X
Switch off all electrical consumers.
Connect the positive terminal clamp and
secure the cover.
X Connect the negative terminal clamp.
X Connect the breather hose. Make sure that
a cell cap is fitted on the side.
X
X
i If the battery power supply has been inter-
Jump-starting
If your vehicle's battery is discharged, the
engine can be jump-started from another
vehicle or from an external battery using jump
leads.
Observe the following points:
RJump-starting may only be performed when
the engine and catalytic converter are cold.
RDo
not start the engine if the battery is frozen. Let the battery thaw first.
RJump-starting
may only be performed from
batteries with a nominal voltage of 12 V.
rupted (e.g. if it has been reconnected), you
must carry out the following tasks:
Rset the time (Y page 109).
ROnly use jump leads which have a sufficient
Rreset the function for folding the exterior
i Jump leads and further information about
mirrors in/out automatically* by folding
the mirrors out once (Y page 72).
Rreset
the side windows (Y page 85)
cross-section and insulated terminal
clamps.
jump-starting can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting
attempts.
Never start the vehicle using a rapid battery
charger.
266
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 267
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Jump-starting
G Risk of injury
There is a risk of acid burns when jumpstarting a vehicle due to the gases which
escape from the battery. Do not lean over
the battery while the engine is being jumpstarted.
G Risk of explosion
Gases escaping from the battery during
jump-starting may cause minor explosions.
Avoid creating sparks. Keep naked flames
away from the battery, and do not smoke.
Comply with safety precautions and take
protective measures when handling batteries. You will find these under "Battery" in
the index.
Make sure that the two vehicles do not
touch.
X Apply the parking brake.
X
Manual transmission: engage neutral.
AUTOTRONIC*: move the DIRECT SELECT
selector lever to P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Open the bonnet (Y page 171).
X
X
* optional
Electrical consumers can be switched on
again. Do not, however, switch on the lights
as this places too heavy a load on the battery.
X Remove the jump lead from earth
point 4 and negative terminal 3 first,
then from positive terminals 1 and 2,
each time disconnecting from the battery
on your own vehicle first.
X Have the battery checked at a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
X
1 Positive terminal of donor battery
2 Positive terminal on your vehicle
3 Negative terminal of donor battery
4 Negative terminal on your vehicle
Open the battery cover (Y page 264).
Connect positive terminal 2 on your vehicle to positive terminal 1 of the donor battery using the jump lead, beginning with
your own battery.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and
run it at idling speed.
X Connect negative terminal 3 of the donor
battery to negative terminal 4 of your
vehicle's battery using the jump lead, connecting the jump lead to the donor battery
first.
X Start the engine.
X
X
Z
267
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 268
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Towing and tow-starting
Towing and tow-starting
Points to remember
G Risk of accident
If you have the vehicle towed, you must use
a rigid towing bar if:
Rthe engine is not running.
Rthere
is a brake system malfunction.
Rthere is a malfunction in the voltage sup-
ply or the vehicle's electrical system.
The electric power steering and the brake
force booster do not work when the engine
is not running. Greater braking force will
then be required and brake pedal travel will
be longer. If necessary, depress the brake
pedal with full force.
Do not tow the vehicle if the key cannot be
turned in the ignition lock. If this is the case,
the steering is locked and the vehicle cannot be steered.
If you tow or tow-start another vehicle, its
weight must not exceed the maximum permissible gross vehicle weight of your vehicle.
It is better to have the vehicle transported
than to have it towed.
268
When towing, observe the legal requirements
in all countries concerned.
! When towing, pull away slowly and with-
out jerking. If the tractive power is too high,
the vehicles could be damaged.
! Do not use the towing eye for recovery,
as this could damage the vehicle. If in
doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum
of 50 km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must
not be exceeded.
With towing distances over 50 km, the
entire vehicle needs to be lifted up and
transported.
! Only secure the tow cable or towing bar
to the towing eyes. You may otherwise
damage the vehicle.
RVehicles
with AUTOTRONIC* must not be
tow-started.
RIf
the engine does not start, try jump-starting it (Y page 266).
RThe
selector lever must be in position N
when towing a vehicle with AUTOTRONIC*.
RIf
you are towing the vehicle over a considerable distance, this must only be done
with the front axle raised.
RThe ignition must be switched off if you are
towing the vehicle with the front/rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
RBefore
towing the vehicle, make sure that
the battery is connected and charged. Otherwise:
- you cannot switch on the ignition
-
you cannot move the selector lever
to N (on vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*)
-
you have no support when braking
i Switch off the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed (Y page 111).
You could otherwise be locked out when
pushing or towing the vehicle.
RIf it is not possible to jump-start the vehicle,
have it towed to the nearest qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 269
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Towing and tow-starting
Fitting the towing eye
Opening the rear cover
Vehicles with a trailer tow hitch: if you
intend to use the vehicle for towing, fit the ball
coupling (Y page 186) and connect the towbar to this.
Towing the vehicle
! You may tow the vehicle for a maximum
of 50 km. A towing speed of 50 km/h must
not be exceeded.
With towing distances over 50 km, the
entire vehicle needs to be lifted up and
transported.
Opening the front cover
The mountings for the removable towing eyes
are in the bumpers. They are located at the
front and rear behind covers on the right-hand
side of the vehicle when viewed in the direction of travel.
! The engine must be switched off (key in
ignition lock in position 0 or position 1) if
the vehicle is being towed with the front
axle raised or if the parking brake is being
tested on a dynamometer. Intervention by
ESP® could otherwise damage the brake
system.
1 Cover
Press cover 1 back in the direction of the
arrow.
X Take cover 1 off the opening.
X
Securing the towing eye
Take the towing eye and the wheel wrench
from the vehicle tool kit (Y page 200).
X Screw in the towing eye clockwise to the
stop.
X Insert the wheel wrench handle into the
towing eye and tighten it.
X
1 Cover
Press cover 1 back in the direction of the
arrow.
X Take cover 1 off the opening.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission
Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
X
Z
269
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 270
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Towing and tow-starting
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
X
Turn the key to position 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Move the selector lever to N.
X
X
Tow-starting (emergency engine
starting)
Please note:
RVehicles with AUTOTRONIC* must not be
tow-started.
RThe
battery must be connected.
RThe engine and catalytic converter must be
cold.
RAvoid
repeated and lengthy starting
attempts.
Tow the vehicle or let it roll.
Shift to a suitable gear and bring the clutch
pedal up slowly. Do not depress the accelerator pedal.
The engine is started.
Transporting the vehicle
The towing eyes or trailer coupling* can be
used to pull the vehicle onto a trailer or transporter if you wish to transport it.
! Only lash the vehicle down by the wheels
or wheel rims, not by parts of the vehicle
such as axle or steering components. The
vehicle could otherwise be damaged.
Removing the towing eye
Take the wheel wrench from the vehicle
tool kit (Y page 200).
X Insert the wheel wrench handle into the
towing eye and turn it anti-clockwise.
X Unscrew the towing eye.
X
Replace the cover and press it until it
engages.
X Return the towing eye and the wheel
wrench to the vehicle tool kit.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission
X
Shift to neutral.
Vehicles with AUTOTRONIC*
Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X Move the selector lever to N.
X
Vehicles with manual transmission
Turn the key to position 2 (Y page 62) in
the ignition lock.
X Fully depress the clutch pedal.
X Shift to neutral.
X
270
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 271
Version: 2.10.6
Practical advice
Fuses
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Otherwise, components or systems could be damaged.
Fuses
Notes on changing fuses
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions will
fail.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognise by
the colour and value. The fuse ratings are listed in the fuse allocation chart. A MercedesBenz Service Centre will be happy to advise
you.
G Risk of fire
Only use fuses that have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which have
the correct fuse rating for the systems concerned. Do not attempt to repair or bridge
faulty fuses. Otherwise, a circuit overload
could cause a fire. Have the cause traced
and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
The fuses are located in the main fuse box in
the front-passenger footwell.
Main fuse box
The main fuse box is in the front-passenger
footwell in front of the seat.
Fuse allocation chart
The fuse allocation chart is in the main fuse
box in the front-passenger footwell.
Before changing a fuse
Park the vehicle.
Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Remove the key from the ignition lock.
X
X
1 Cover
2 Retaining screw
Remove the footmats*.
Turn retaining screw 2 anti-clockwise, e.g.
with a coin.
X Lift up cover 1.
X Remove the cover mat from the battery.
X
X
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
Z
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
* optional
271
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
Practical advice
Fuses
1 Fuse allocation chart
2 Main fuse box
272
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 272
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 273
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Introduction to technical data .........
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts .........
Vehicle electronics ...........................
Vehicle identification plates ............
Engine ................................................
Performance ......................................
Tyres and wheels ..............................
Vehicle dimensions ..........................
Vehicle weights .................................
274
274
275
276
278
280
282
286
286
Trailer coupling* ............................... 290
Service products and capacities ..... 292
273
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 274
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Introduction to technical data
i The technical data was determined in
accordance with EU directives. All data
applies to the vehicle's standard equipment. The data may therefore differ for
vehicles with optional equipment. You can
obtain further information from a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
Mercedes-Benz tests genuine parts and conversion parts and accessories which have
been specifically approved for your vehicle for
their reliability, safety and suitability. Despite
ongoing market research, Mercedes-Benz is
unable to evaluate other parts. Therefore,
Mercedes-Benz accepts no responsibility for
the use of such parts in Mercedes-Benz vehicles, even if they have been independently or
officially approved.
In Germany and some other countries, certain
parts are only officially approved for installation or modification if they comply with legal
requirements. All genuine Mercedes-Benz
parts meet this requirement. The use of nonapproved parts may invalidate the vehicle's
general operating permit. This is the case if:
Rthey cause a change of the vehicle type
from that for which the vehicle's general
operating permit was granted
Rother
road users could be endangered
Rthe
emission or noise levels are adversely
affected
The use of non-approved parts could affect
your vehicle's operating safety. Therefore,
Mercedes-Benz recommends genuine
274
Mercedes-Benz parts and conversion parts
and accessories that have been approved for
your vehicle.
H Environmental note
Daimler also supplies reconditioned
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. For these, the same
warranty applies as for new parts.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts and approved
conversion parts and accessories are available from Mercedes-Benz Service Centres.
There, you can also receive advice about technical modifications and have the parts professionally fitted.
Always quote the vehicle identification number and the engine number when ordering
genuine parts. For example, you will find
these numbers on your vehicle's identification plates (Y page 276).
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 275
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle electronics
Vehicle electronics
Tampering with the engine electronics
G Risk of accident
Only have work on the engine electronics
and related components carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools
to carry out the work required. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
The vehicle's roadworthiness could otherwise be affected.
! Only have work done on the engine elec-
tronics and its associated parts, such as
control units, sensors and connector leads,
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre. Otherwise, vehicle components
may wear more quickly and your vehicle's
warranty and operating permit may be invalidated.
Retrofitting electrical and electronic
equipment
Electrical and electronic equipment can jeopardise the operating safety of your vehicle. If
equipment of this kind is retrofitted, it must
be type-approved and bear the e mark. The
e mark may be obtained from the equipment
manufacturer or an authorised testing centre.
! Damage or consequential damage arising
from fitting equipment not approved by
Mercedes-Benz is not covered by the
Mercedes-Benz warranty.
If you wish to install two-way radios in the
vehicle, you must obtain formal approval.
Mercedes-Benz approves the installation of
two-way radios if such equipment is installed
professionally and a low-reflection exterior
aerial is used.
The transmission output of the two-way radio
must not exceed the maximum transmission
outputs listed.
G Risk of accident
Two-way radios may interfere with the vehicle electronics and thereby jeopardise the
operational safety of the vehicle and your
own safety if:
Rthey
do not have an exterior aerial
Rthe
exterior aerial is not a low-reflection
aerial
Rthe
exterior aerial has been fitted incorrectly
G Risk of injury
Excessive electromagnetic radiation may
also cause damage to your health and the
health of others. Using an exterior aerial
takes into account current scientific discussions relating to the possible health hazards that may result from electromagnetic
fields.
For this reason, only have the exterior aerial
fitted at a qualified specialist workshop
which has the necessary specialist knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you use a Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre for this purpose. In particular, work
relevant to safety or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Mercedes-Benz recommends the use of
an approved exterior aerial. This ensures
optimal reception quality for mobile tele-
275
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 276
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle identification plates
phones/wireless devices in the vehicle.
This also ensures that interference
between these devices and the vehicle's
electronics is kept to a minimum. If installed, the exterior aerial conducts the electromagnetic fields transmitted by a mobile
phone to the exterior of the vehicle.
Vehicle identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN) and
paint code number
The vehicle identification plate is located at
the bottom of the door frame on the frontpassenger side.
Frequency range
Maximum transmission output
(watts)
Short wave
(< 50 MHz)
100
Vehicle identification plate (example)
1 Vehicle identification plate
4 m waveband
20
2 Vehicle manufacturer
3 EU type approval number
2 m waveband
50
70 cm waveband
35
25 cm waveband
10
! If electrical or electronic equipment
which does not comply with the above
installation conditions is operated inside
the vehicle, the vehicle's operating permit
may be invalidated (EU Directive
95/54/EC - Automotive EMC directive)
276
4 Vehicle identification number (VIN)
5 Maximum permissible gross vehicle
weight
1 Vehicle identification plate
X
Open the driver's door.
You will see vehicle identification plate
1.
6 Maximum permissible towing weight
7 Maximum permissible front axle load
8 Maximum permissible rear axle load
9 Paint code number
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 277
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle identification plates
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
In addition to the information on the vehicle
identification plate, the vehicle identification
number (VIN) is also stamped onto the vehicle
body. It is located in the engine compartment
below the windscreen frame.
X
Open the bonnet (Y page 171).
You will see vehicle identification number
(VIN) 1.
Engine number
The engine number is stamped on the engine
block (crankcase). More information can be
obtained from any Mercedes-Benz Service
Centre.
1 Vehicle identification number (VIN)
Z
277
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 278
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Engine
Engine
A 150
A 150 BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170 BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
A 200 TURBO
70 kW (95 bhp)
85 kW (116 bhp)
100 kW (136 bhp)
142 kW (193 bhp)
5,200 rpm
5,500 rpm
5,500 rpm
5,000 rpm
140 Nm
155 Nm
185 Nm
280 Nm
3,500 – 4,000 rpm
3,500 – 4,000 rpm
3,500 – 4,000 rpm
1,800 – 4,850 rpm
4
4
4
4
Displacement
1,498 cm3
1,699 cm3
2,034 cm3
2,034 cm3
Maximum engine
speed
6,300 rpm
6,300 rpm
6,300 rpm
6,000 rpm
Rated output
At engine speed
Rated torque
At engine speed
Number of cylinders
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
60 kW (82 bhp)
80 kW (109 bhp)
103 kW (140 bhp)
4,200 rpm
4,200 rpm
4,200 rpm
Rated torque
180 Nm (200 Nm)34
250 Nm
300 Nm (280 Nm)34
At engine speed
1,400 – 2,600 rpm
1,600 – 2,600 rpm
1,600 – 3,000 rpm
4
4
4
Rated output
At engine speed
Number of cylinders
34 Vehicles
278
with AUTOTRONIC*
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 279
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Engine
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Displacement
1,991 cm3
1,991 cm3
1,991 cm3
Maximum engine
speed
4,800 rpm
4,800 rpm
4,800 rpm
Z
279
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 280
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Performance
Performance
Speeds
Manual transmission
Maximum speed
A 150
A 170
A 150 BlueEFFICIENCY A 170 BlueEFFICIENCY
175 km/h
188 km/h
A 200
A 200 TURBO
200 km/h
228 km/h
Manual transmission
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Maximum speed
170 km/h
186 km/h
201 km/h
AUTOTRONIC*
Maximum speed
A 150
A 170
A 200
A 200 TURBO
170 km/h
183 km/h
195 km/h
220 km/h
AUTOTRONIC*
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Maximum speed
165 km/h
181 km/h
196 km/h
280
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 281
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Performance
Acceleration from 0 to 100 km/h
A 150
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
Manual transmission
12.6 seconds
12.6 seconds
10.9 seconds
10.9 seconds
9.8 seconds
AUTOTRONIC*
13.5 seconds
–
11.5 seconds
–
9.9 seconds
A 200
TURBO
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Manual transmission
7.5 seconds
15 seconds
10.8 seconds
9.5 seconds
AUTOTRONIC*
7.3 seconds
15.3 seconds
11.1 seconds
9.6 seconds
Z
* optional
281
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 282
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Tyres and wheels
Tyres and wheels
Points to remember
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tyres which
have been approved specifically for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. These tyres are
specially adapted for use with the control
systems, such as ABS or ESP®, and are
marked as follows:
RMO = Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE
= Mercedes-Benz Original Extended* (with run-flat characteristics)
If you use other tyres, Mercedes-Benz cannot accept any responsibility for damage
which may occur. Information about tyres
35 Only
282
can be obtained from any Mercedes-Benz
Service Centre.
i Vehicles with MOExtended run-flat sys-
tem are not equipped with the TIREFIT
kit*35.
Therefore, it is recommended that you
additionally equip your vehicle with the
TIREFIT kit* when fitting tyres that do not
feature run-flat properties, e.g. winter
tyres.
i A TIREFIT kit* is available from any qualified specialist workshop, e.g. a MercedesBenz Service Centre.
! If you fit tyres other than those tested and
recommended by Mercedes-Benz, charac-
teristics such as handling, noise levels and
fuel consumption, etc. may be adversely
affected. In addition, when driving with a
load, tyre dimensional variations could
cause the tyres to come into contact with
the bodywork and axle components. This
could result in damage to the tyres or the
vehicle.
i Further information about tyres and
wheels can be obtained from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
You will find a table of tyre pressures on the
inside of your vehicle's fuel filler flap. You
will find further information about tyre pressures in the "Operation" section
(Y page 178).
for certain countries.
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 283
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Tyres and wheels
Tyres
15"
Both
axles
16"
Both
axles
17"
Both
axles
A 150 /
A 150 BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 170 /
A 170 BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 160 CDI /
A 160 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 180 CDI
A 200 /
A 200 CDI
A 200 TURBO
Summer tyres
185/65 R15 88T
–
–
Winter tyres
185/65 R15 88T M+S.
Wheels
6J x 15 H2 ET 44
–
–
Summer tyres
195/55 R16 87T
195/55 R16 87H
195/55 R16 87V
Winter tyres
195/55 R16 87T M+S.
195/55 R16 87T M+S.
195/55 R16 87T M+S.
Wheels
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
215/45 R17 87V
215/45 R17 87V
215/45 R17 87V
7J x 17 H2 ET 54
7J x 17 H2 ET 54
7J x 17 H2 ET 54
Summer
Wheels
tyres36, 37
Z
36 Snow
37 Only
chains only permitted as a starting-off aid.
with sports suspension.
283
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 284
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Tyres and wheels
AMG equipment*
All models
18"
Both axles
Summer tyres38, 39
215/40 R 18 89W XL
Light-alloy wheels
7J x 18 H2 ET 54
MOExtended tyres*
i Tyres with run-flat characteristics, only in conjunction with light-alloy wheels and tyre pressure loss warning system.
All models40
16"
17"
Both axles
Both axles
Winter tyres41, 42
195/55 R16 87H M+S MOExtended
Light-alloy wheels43
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
Summer tyres41, 44
215/45 R17 87V MOExtended
Light-alloy wheels43
7J x 17 H2 ET 54
38 Use
of snow chains not permitted.
with sports suspension.
40 Only with sports suspension.
41 Tyres with run-flat characteristics, only available in conjunction with tyre pressure loss warning system and tyre pressure monitor*.
42 Not available from the factory. You can obtain further information from a specialist workshop, e.g. a Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
43 Not on steel wheels.
44 Snow chains only permitted as a pull-away aid.
39 Only
284
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 285
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Tyres and wheels
Spare wheel*
Your vehicle may be equipped with TIREFIT, a "Minispare" emergency spare wheel* or a spare wheel*, depending on the country, the engine
and the wheels fitted.
i Vehicles with MOExtended tyres (tyres with run-flat characteristics) are not equipped with a TIREFIT kit at the factory.
15"
16"
16"
A 150 /
A 150 BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 170 /
A 170 BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 160 CDI /
A 160 CDI BlueEFFICIENCY /
A 180 CDI
A 200 /
A 200 CDI
A 200 TURBO
Remove the spare
wheel*
Summer tyres
185/65 R15 88T
–
–
Steel spare
wheel
6J x 15 H2 ET 44
–
–
Remove the spare
wheel*
Summer tyres
–
195/55 R16 87H
195/55 R16 87V
Steel spare
wheel
–
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
6J x 16 H2 ET 46
T 125/90 R16 98M
T 125/90 R16 98M
T 125/90 R16 98M
4.2 bar
4.2 bar
4.2 bar
3.5B x 16 H2 ET 32
3.5B x 16 H2 ET 32
3.5B x 16 H2 ET 32
"Minispare " emergency Tyres
spare wheel*45
Tyre pressure
Wheels
Z
45 Use
of snow chains not possible.
* optional
285
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 286
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle weights
Vehicle dimensions
A 150
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
Vehicle length (ECE)
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
Vehicle width including exterior mirrors
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
Vehicle height
1,593 mm
1,593 mm
1,593 mm
1,593 mm
1,595 mm
Wheelbase
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
A 200 TURBO
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Vehicle length (ECE)
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
3,883 mm
Vehicle width including exterior mirrors
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
2,040 mm
Vehicle height
1,595 mm
1,593 mm
1,593 mm
1,595 mm
Wheelbase
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
2,568 mm
Vehicle weights
The unladen weight includes the driver (68 kg), luggage (7 kg) and all fluids (fuel tank 90% full). Items of optional equipment increase the
unladen weight and reduce the maximum payload. You will find more specific weight information on the vehicle identification plate
(Y page 276).
286
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 287
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle weights
A 150
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
Unladen weight
5-door vehi(in accordance
cle
with EC directive)
3-door vehicle
1,225 kg
1,245 kg
1,240 kg
1,260 kg
1,270 kg
1,195 kg
1,215 kg
1,210 kg
1,230 kg
1,240 kg
Maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight
5-door vehicle
1,740 kg
1,740 kg
1,770 kg
1,770 kg
1,765 kg
3-door vehicle
1,740 kg
1,740 kg
1,770 kg
1,770 kg
1,765 kg
Maximum permissible front
axle load
5-door vehicle
860 kg
860 kg
885 kg
885 kg
890 kg
3-door vehicle
860 kg
860 kg
885 kg
885 kg
890 kg
Maximum per5-door vehimissible rear axle cle
load
3-door vehicle
880 kg
880 kg
885 kg
885 kg
875 kg
880 kg
880 kg
885 kg
885 kg
875 kg
Towing a trailer
5-door vehicle
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
3-door vehicle
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
920 kg
Z
287
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 288
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle weights
A 150
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
Maximum roof
load
50 kg
50 kg
50 kg
50 kg
50 kg
Maximum luggage compartment load
100 kg
100 kg
100 kg
100 kg
100 kg
A 200 TURBO
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Unladen weight
5-door vehi(in accordance
cle
with EC directive)
3-door vehicle
1,305 kg
1,325 kg
1,345 kg
1365 kg
1,275 kg
1,300 kg
1,320 kg
1,340 kg
Maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight
5-door vehicle
1,835 kg
1,835 kg
1,830 kg
1,880 kg
3-door vehicle
1,835 kg
1,835 kg
1,830 kg
1,880 kg
Maximum permissible front
axle load
5-door vehicle
945 kg
935 kg
935 kg
980 kg
3-door vehicle
945 kg
935 kg
935 kg
980 kg
288
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 289
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Vehicle weights
A 200 TURBO
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Maximum permissible rear
axle load
5-door vehicle
890 kg
900 kg
895 kg
900 kg
3-door vehicle
890 kg
900 kg
895 kg
900 kg
Towing a trailer
5-door vehicle
935 kg
935 kg
935 kg
935 kg
3-door vehicle
935 kg
935 kg
935 kg
935 kg
Maximum roof
load
50 kg
50 kg
50 kg
50 kg
Maximum luggage compartment load
100 kg
100 kg
100 kg
100 kg
Z
289
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 290
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Trailer coupling*
Trailer coupling*
Mounting dimensions
If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
observe the anchorage points on the chassis frame.
For trailer couplings fitted at the factory, the
overhang dimension is 749 mm.
G Risk of accident
Only have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted at a
qualified specialist workshop which has the
necessary specialist knowledge and tools
to carry out the work required. MercedesBenz recommends that you use a
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre for this purpose. In particular, work relevant to safety
or on safety-related systems must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
! If you have a trailer tow hitch retrofitted,
changes to the cooling system may be necessary, depending on the vehicle type.
Anchorage points for the trailer coupling
1 Anchorage points
2 Overhang dimension
3 Rear axle centre line
290
* optional
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 291
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Trailer coupling*
Trailer loads
A 150
A 150
BlueEfficiency
A 170
A 170
BlueEfficiency
A 200
A 200 TURBO
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Permissible trailer load, braked46
1,000 kg
1,300 kg
1,500 kg
1,000 kg
1,500 kg
Permissible trailer load, unbraked
595 kg
595 kg
595 kg
645 kg
645 kg
Maximum drawbar noseweight47
75 kg
75 kg
75 kg
75 kg
75 kg
46 At
Z
a minimum gradient-climbing capability of 12 % from a standstill.
drawbar noseweight is not included in the trailer load.
47 The
* optional
291
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 292
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Service products and capacities
Notes on service products and capacities
Service products are:
Rfuels (e.g. petrol, diesel)
Rlubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
Rcoolant
Rbrake
fluid
Rwindscreen
washer fluid
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use those products which have been tested
and specially approved by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle and are listed in the MercedesBenz Owner's Manual in the relevant chapter
since:
Rparts and service products are matched
Rdamage caused by the use of non-approved
service products is not covered by the warranty
You can recognise service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers:
RMB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB
292
Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations that
relate to a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Approval have not
necessarily been approved by MercedesBenz.
You can obtain further information from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre.
G Risk of injury
When handling, storing and disposing of
any service products, please observe the
relevant regulations, as you could otherwise endanger yourself and others.
Keep service products away from children.
To protect your health, do not allow service
products to come into contact with your
eyes or open wounds. See a doctor immediately if any service product is swallowed.
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally-responsible manner.
Fuels
G Risk of explosion
Fuel is highly flammable. Fire, naked flames
and smoking are therefore prohibited when
handling fuels.
Before refuelling, always turn off the
engine.
G Risk of injury
Do not allow fuel to come into contact with
skin or clothing.
Allowing fuels to come into direct contact
with your skin or inhaling fuel vapours is
damaging to your health.
Tank capacity
Total capacity
54 l
Of which reserve
fuel
Approximately 6 l
! Do not use petrol to refuel vehicles with a
diesel engine. Do not use diesel to refuel
vehicles with a petrol engine. Never mix
diesel with petrol. Even small amounts of
the wrong fuel result in damage to the
injection system. Damage resulting from
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 293
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
adding the wrong fuel is not covered by the
warranty.
More information about refuelling and fuels
can be found on (Y page 168).
Introduction to fuel consumption
The vehicle will use more fuel than usual in
the following situations:
Rat very low temperatures
Rin
urban traffic
Ron
short trips
Rwhen
Rin
towing a trailer
mountainous terrain
The consumption figures have been determined according to EU Directive
RL 80 / 1268 / EEC.
i Only for certain countries: the respective
current consumption and emission values
of your vehicle can be found in the COC
papers (EC-CERTIFICATE OF CONFORMITY). These documents are supplied when
the vehicle is delivered.
! Do not use any special additives, as they
can cause malfunctions and engine damage. Damage resulting from the use of such
additives is not covered by the MercedesBenz warranty.
H Environmental note
CO2 (carbon dioxide) is the gas which scientists believe to be principally responsible
for global warming (the greenhouse effect).
Your vehicle's CO2 emissions are directly
related to fuel consumption and therefore
depend on:
Refficient use of the fuel by the engine
Rdriving
style
Rother non-technical factors, such as envi-
ronmental influences or road conditions
You can minimise your vehicle's CO2 emissions by driving carefully and having it serviced regularly.
Z
293
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 294
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Fuel consumption
The consumption figures have been determined according to applicable EU Directives and do not refer to one specific vehicle. Deviations
from these values may occur under normal operating conditions.
Manual transmission
A 150
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
Urban
7.9 – 8.4 l/100 km
7.4 – 7.8 l/100 km
8.6 – 8.7 l/100 km
8.0 – 8.4 l/100 km
Extra-urban
5.4 – 5.7 l/100 km
5.1 – 5.5 l/100 km
5.5 – 5.8 l/100 km
5.1 – 5.5 l/100 km
Overall (NEDC)
6.2 – 6.7 l/100 km
5.8 – 6.2 l/100 km
6.6 – 6.8 l/100 km
6.1 – 6.5 l/100 km
CO2emissions
148 – 159 g/km
139 – 149 g/km
157 – 163 g/km
146 – 154 g/km
Manual transmission
A 200
A 200 TURBO
Urban
9.6 - 9.6 l/100 km
10.5 – 10.7 l/100 km
Extra-urban
5.9 – 6.1 l/100 km
6.4 – 6.6 l/100 km
Overall (NEDC)
7.2 – 7.4 l/100 km
7.9 – 8.1 l/100 km
CO2emissions
172 – 176 g/km
187 – 192 g/km
A 150
A 170
A 200
A 200 TURBO
Urban
8.5 – 8.7 l/100 km
8.6 – 9.0 l/100 km
9.6 - 9.6 l/100 km
10.2 – 10.3 l/100 km
Extra-urban
5.5 – 6.0 l/100 km
5.5 – 6.0 l/100 km
5.9 – 6.1 l/100 km
6.5 – 6.6 l/100 km
AUTOTRONIC*
294
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 295
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
AUTOTRONIC*
A 150
A 170
A 200
A 200 TURBO
Overall (NEDC)
6.6 – 7.0 l/100 km
6.6 – 7.1 l/100 km
7.2 – 7.4 l/100 km
7.9 – 8.1 l/100 km
CO2emissions
157 – 166 g/km
157 – 169 g/km
172 – 176 g/km
187 – 192 g/km
Manual transmission
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Urban
6.2 – 6.5 l/100 km
6.4 – 6.5 l/100 km
6.8 – 6.9 l/100 km
Extra-urban
4.3 – 4.5 l/100 km
4.2 – 4.4 l/100 km
4.5 – 4.6 l/100 km
Overall (NEDC)
4.9 – 5.2 l/100 km
5.0 – 5.2 l/100 km
5.3 – 5.4 l/100 km
CO2emissions
128 – 137 g/km
134 – 138 g/km
138 – 140 g/km
AUTOTRONIC*
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Urban
7.0 – 7.6 l/100 km
7.0 – 7.6 l/100 km
7.1 – 7.9 l/100 km
Extra-urban
4.4 – 4.9 l/100 km
4.4 – 4.9 l/100 km
4.9 – 5.0 l/100 km
Overall (NEDC)
5.4 – 5.8 l/100 km
5.4 – 5.8 l/100 km
5.7 – 6.0 l/100 km
CO2emissions
142 – 154 g/km
142 – 154 g/km
149 – 159 g/km
Z
* optional
295
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 296
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Engine oil
A list of engine oils tested and approved in accordance with the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products is available from any
Mercedes-Benz Service Centre. Engine oils which have been approved by Mercedes-Benz have the MB Sheet number indicated on the oil
container. The table shows which MB Sheet Number applies to which engine:
A 150
A 150 BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170 BlueEFFICIENCY
A 200
A 200 TURBO
229.3/229.31
229.5/229.51
229.3/229.31
229.5/229.51
229.3/229.31
229.5/229.51
229.3/229.31
229.5/229.51
MB Sheet Number
With a diesel particulate filter
MB Sheet Number
Without a diesel particle filter48
MB Sheet Number
i In the event that the:
Rengine
Rgrade
RSAE
48 Only
296
oil brand
(MB Sheet number)
classification (viscosity)
for certain countries.
A 160 CDI
A 160 CDI BlueFFICIENCY
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
228.51/229.31/229.51
228.51/229.31/229.51
228.51/229.31/229.51
A 160 CDI
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
228.3/228.5/228.51
229.3/229.31/229.5/229.51
228.3/228.5/228.51
229.3/229.31/229.5/229.51
228.3/228.5/228.51
229.3/229.31/229.5/229.51
is not available, you can use another mineral or synthetic engine oil which has been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Mixing oils reduces the benefits of highgrade engine oil.
! Do not use lubricant additives as they can
lead to increased wear and damage to
mechanical assemblies. The use of lubricant additives will result in a restriction of
your warranty.
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 297
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
! Engine oils for vehicles without a diesel
in vehicles with a diesel particle filter if the
engine oil listed is not available. You must
particle filter may also be used temporarily
then have an oil change carried out as soon
as possible.
Capacities
The following values refer to an oil change including the oil filter.
Engine with oil filter
A 150
A 150 BlueFFICIENCY
A 170
A 170 BlueFFICIENCY
A 200
A 200 TURBO
Replacement amount
5.0 l
5.0 l
5.0 l
5.0 l
Engine with oil filter
A 160 CDI
A 160 CDI BlueFFICIENCY
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
Replacement amount
5.8 l
5.4 l
5.4 l
! Only top up with coolant that has been
Coolant
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the
following tasks:
Ranti-corrosion protection
Rantifreeze
Rraising
protection
the boiling point
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is
topped up with a coolant that will ensure
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
premixed with the desired antifreeze protection. You could otherwise damage the
engine.
More information on coolant and refilling
can be found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Service Products, sheet no.
310.1 and is available from any MercedesBenz Service Centre.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the cooling system will not be
sufficiently protected from corrosion, and
the boiling point will be too low.
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant will be around 130 °C.
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the cooling system should:
297
Z
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the cooling
system against freezing down to around –
37 °C.
Rnot
exceed 55% concentration (antifreeze
protection down to –45 °C); otherwise,
heat will not be effectively dissipated.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, top it up with
equal amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor
which has been approved for Mercedes-Benz.
! The cooling system contains a filling
which must be renewed after 15 years, or
after 250, 000 km at the latest.
The warranty is only valid if you top up with
an antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor which
has been approved by Mercedes-Benz, and
observe the recommended mixing ratios.
298
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 298
Version: 2.10.6
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 299
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Capacities
The following values indicate the total cooling system capacities.
Coolant
A 150
Manual transmission
A 150
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 150
AUTOTRONIC*
A 170
Manual transmission
A 170
BlueEFFICIENCY
A 170
AUTOTRONIC*
6.3 l
6.3 l
6.5 l
6.3 l
6.3 l
6.6 l
Amount of antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor required for antifreeze protection
Down to –37 °C
(approx. 50%)
3.2 l
3.2 l
3.25 l
3.2 l
3.2 l
3.3 l
Down to –45 °C
(approx. 55%)
3.5 l
3.5 l
3.6 l
3.5 l
3.5 l
3.65 l
Coolant
A 200
A 200
TURBO
A 160 CDI
Manual transmission
A 160 CDI
AUTOTRONIC*
A 180 CDI
A 200 CDI
6.6 l
8.5 l
8.4 l
8.0 l
9.7 l
Amount of antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor required for antifreeze protection
Down to –37 °C
(approx. 50%)
3.3 l
4.25 l
4.2 l
4.0 l
4.85 l
Down to –45 °C
(approx. 55%)
3.65 l
4.7 l
4.6 l
4.4 l
5.35 l
Z
* optional
299
Dateiname: 6515_0315_02_buchblock.pdf;
169_AKB; 2; 4, en-GB
wdomann,
preflight
2008-07-16T08:52:06+02:00 - Seite 300
Version: 2.10.6
Technical data
Service products and capacities
Brake fluid
Over a period of time, the brake fluid absorbs
moisture from the air; this lowers its boiling
point.
G Risk of accident
If the boiling point of the brake fluid is too
low, vapour pockets may form in the brake
system when the brakes are applied hard
(e.g. when driving downhill). This would
impair braking efficiency.
Have the brake fluid renewed every two
years with a brake fluid that has been
approved by Mercedes-Benz and have this
confirmed in the Service Booklet.
Windscreen washer system
G Risk of fire
Windscreen washer concentrate is highly
flammable. Fire, naked flames and smoking
are prohibited when windscreen washer
concentrate is being handled.
The washer fluid reservoir holds approximately 4.5 litres.
The headlamp cleaning system* and the
windscreen washer system are both supplied
from the washer fluid reservoir.
Further information on windshield washer
fluid and the mixing ratio can be found on
(Y page 175).
i There is usually a notice in the engine
compartment to remind you when the next
brake fluid change is due.
300
* optional